annotate runtime/doc/usr_41.txt @ 25006:496221916885 v8.2.3040

patch 8.2.3040: GUI: dropping files not tested Commit: https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/18d46587b985923ef4b90b19a0cf37a094607fec Author: Yegappan Lakshmanan <yegappan@yahoo.com> Date: Wed Jun 23 20:46:52 2021 +0200 patch 8.2.3040: GUI: dropping files not tested Problem: GUI: dropping files not tested. Solution: Add test_gui_drop_files() and tests. (Yegappan Lakshmanan, closes #8434)
author Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
date Wed, 23 Jun 2021 21:00:03 +0200
parents 4cb423b9250d
children c626fd34b66f
Ignore whitespace changes - Everywhere: Within whitespace: At end of lines:
rev   line source
24911
fd37be6dc258 Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 24840
diff changeset
1 *usr_41.txt* For Vim version 8.2. Last change: 2021 Jun 07
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3 VIM USER MANUAL - by Bram Moolenaar
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5 Write a Vim script
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8 The Vim script language is used for the startup vimrc file, syntax files, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
9 many other things. This chapter explains the items that can be used in a Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
10 script. There are a lot of them, thus this is a long chapter.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
11
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
12 |41.1| Introduction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
13 |41.2| Variables
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
14 |41.3| Expressions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
15 |41.4| Conditionals
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
16 |41.5| Executing an expression
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
17 |41.6| Using functions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
18 |41.7| Defining a function
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
19 |41.8| Lists and Dictionaries
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
20 |41.9| Exceptions
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
21 |41.10| Various remarks
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
22 |41.11| Writing a plugin
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
23 |41.12| Writing a filetype plugin
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
24 |41.13| Writing a compiler plugin
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
25 |41.14| Writing a plugin that loads quickly
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
26 |41.15| Writing library scripts
793
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
27 |41.16| Distributing Vim scripts
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
28
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
29 Next chapter: |usr_42.txt| Add new menus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
30 Previous chapter: |usr_40.txt| Make new commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
31 Table of contents: |usr_toc.txt|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
32
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
33 ==============================================================================
129
2983cde45542 updated for version 7.0044
vimboss
parents: 112
diff changeset
34 *41.1* Introduction *vim-script-intro* *script*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
35
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
36 Your first experience with Vim scripts is the vimrc file. Vim reads it when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
37 it starts up and executes the commands. You can set options to values you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
38 prefer. And you can use any colon command in it (commands that start with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
39 ":"; these are sometimes referred to as Ex commands or command-line commands).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
40 Syntax files are also Vim scripts. As are files that set options for a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
41 specific file type. A complicated macro can be defined by a separate Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
42 script file. You can think of other uses yourself.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
43
20856
83cfa1ef1bf2 Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20836
diff changeset
44 If you are familiar with Python, you can find a comparison between
83cfa1ef1bf2 Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20836
diff changeset
45 Python and Vim script here, with pointers to other documents:
83cfa1ef1bf2 Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20836
diff changeset
46 https://gist.github.com/yegappan/16d964a37ead0979b05e655aa036cad0
21676
1b345fb68ae3 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20856
diff changeset
47 And if you are familiar with JavaScript:
20856
83cfa1ef1bf2 Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20836
diff changeset
48 https://w0rp.com/blog/post/vim-script-for-the-javascripter/
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
49
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
50 Let's start with a simple example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
51
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
52 :let i = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
53 :while i < 5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
54 : echo "count is" i
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
55 : let i += 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
56 :endwhile
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
57 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
58 Note:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
59 The ":" characters are not really needed here. You only need to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
60 them when you type a command. In a Vim script file they can be left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
61 out. We will use them here anyway to make clear these are colon
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
62 commands and make them stand out from Normal mode commands.
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
63 Note:
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
64 You can try out the examples by yanking the lines from the text here
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
65 and executing them with :@"
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
66
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
67 The output of the example code is:
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
68
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
69 count is 1 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
70 count is 2 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
71 count is 3 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
72 count is 4 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
73
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
74 In the first line the ":let" command assigns a value to a variable. The
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
75 generic form is: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
76
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
77 :let {variable} = {expression}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
78
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
79 In this case the variable name is "i" and the expression is a simple value,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
80 the number one.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
81 The ":while" command starts a loop. The generic form is: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
82
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
83 :while {condition}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
84 : {statements}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
85 :endwhile
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
86
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
87 The statements until the matching ":endwhile" are executed for as long as the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
88 condition is true. The condition used here is the expression "i < 5". This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
89 is true when the variable i is smaller than five.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
90 Note:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
91 If you happen to write a while loop that keeps on running, you can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
92 interrupt it by pressing CTRL-C (CTRL-Break on MS-Windows).
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
93
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
94 The ":echo" command prints its arguments. In this case the string "count is"
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
95 and the value of the variable i. Since i is one, this will print:
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
96
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
97 count is 1 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
98
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
99 Then there is the ":let i += 1" command. This does the same thing as
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
100 ":let i = i + 1". This adds one to the variable i and assigns the new value
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
101 to the same variable.
20856
83cfa1ef1bf2 Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20836
diff changeset
102 Note: this is how it works in legacy Vim script, which is what we discuss in
83cfa1ef1bf2 Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20836
diff changeset
103 this file. In Vim9 script it's a bit different, see |usr_46.txt|.
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
104
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
105 The example was given to explain the commands, but would you really want to
11062
1218c5353e2b Runtime file updates.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 10734
diff changeset
106 make such a loop, it can be written much more compact: >
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
107
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
108 :for i in range(1, 4)
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
109 : echo "count is" i
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
110 :endfor
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
111
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
112 We won't explain how |:for| and |range()| work until later. Follow the links
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
113 if you are impatient.
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
114
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
115
16871
e5dab34ded73 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16808
diff changeset
116 FOUR KINDS OF NUMBERS
e5dab34ded73 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16808
diff changeset
117
24520
5bda4653aced Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 24313
diff changeset
118 Numbers can be decimal, hexadecimal, octal or binary.
5bda4653aced Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 24313
diff changeset
119
5bda4653aced Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 24313
diff changeset
120 A hexadecimal number starts with "0x" or "0X". For example "0x1f" is decimal
5bda4653aced Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 24313
diff changeset
121 31.
5bda4653aced Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 24313
diff changeset
122
5bda4653aced Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 24313
diff changeset
123 An octal number starts with "0o", "0O" or a zero and another digit. "0o17" is
5bda4653aced Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 24313
diff changeset
124 decimal 15. Using just a zero prefix is not supported in Vim9 script.
5bda4653aced Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 24313
diff changeset
125
5bda4653aced Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 24313
diff changeset
126 A binary number starts with "0b" or "0B". For example "0b101" is decimal 5.
5bda4653aced Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 24313
diff changeset
127
5bda4653aced Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 24313
diff changeset
128 A decimal number is just digits. Careful: don't put a zero before a decimal
5bda4653aced Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 24313
diff changeset
129 number, it will be interpreted as an octal number in legacy script!
5bda4653aced Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 24313
diff changeset
130
5bda4653aced Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 24313
diff changeset
131 The ":echo" command always prints decimal numbers. Example: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
132
23573
e2e2cc5d0856 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23563
diff changeset
133 :echo 0x7f 0o36
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
134 < 127 30 ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
135
16871
e5dab34ded73 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16808
diff changeset
136 A number is made negative with a minus sign. This also works for hexadecimal,
e5dab34ded73 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16808
diff changeset
137 octal and binary numbers. A minus sign is also used for subtraction. Compare
e5dab34ded73 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16808
diff changeset
138 this with the previous example: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
139
23573
e2e2cc5d0856 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23563
diff changeset
140 :echo 0x7f -0o36
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
141 < 97 ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
142
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
143 White space in an expression is ignored. However, it's recommended to use it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
144 for separating items, to make the expression easier to read. For example, to
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
145 avoid the confusion with a negative number above, put a space between the
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
146 minus sign and the following number: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
147
23573
e2e2cc5d0856 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23563
diff changeset
148 :echo 0x7f - 0o36
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
149
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
150 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
151 *41.2* Variables
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
152
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
153 A variable name consists of ASCII letters, digits and the underscore. It
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
154 cannot start with a digit. Valid variable names are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
155
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
156 counter
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
157 _aap3
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
158 very_long_variable_name_with_underscores
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
159 FuncLength
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
160 LENGTH
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
161
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
162 Invalid names are "foo+bar" and "6var".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
163 These variables are global. To see a list of currently defined variables
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
164 use this command: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
165
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
166 :let
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
167
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
168 You can use global variables everywhere. This also means that when the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
169 variable "count" is used in one script file, it might also be used in another
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
170 file. This leads to confusion at least, and real problems at worst. To avoid
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
171 this, you can use a variable local to a script file by prepending "s:". For
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
172 example, one script contains this code: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
173
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
174 :let s:count = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
175 :while s:count < 5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
176 : source other.vim
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
177 : let s:count += 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
178 :endwhile
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
179
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
180 Since "s:count" is local to this script, you can be sure that sourcing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
181 "other.vim" script will not change this variable. If "other.vim" also uses an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
182 "s:count" variable, it will be a different copy, local to that script. More
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
183 about script-local variables here: |script-variable|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
184
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
185 There are more kinds of variables, see |internal-variables|. The most often
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
186 used ones are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
187
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
188 b:name variable local to a buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
189 w:name variable local to a window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
190 g:name global variable (also in a function)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
191 v:name variable predefined by Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
192
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
193
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
194 DELETING VARIABLES
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
195
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
196 Variables take up memory and show up in the output of the ":let" command. To
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
197 delete a variable use the ":unlet" command. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
198
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
199 :unlet s:count
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
200
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
201 This deletes the script-local variable "s:count" to free up the memory it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
202 uses. If you are not sure if the variable exists, and don't want an error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
203 message when it doesn't, append !: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
204
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
205 :unlet! s:count
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
206
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
207 When a script finishes, the local variables used there will not be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
208 automatically freed. The next time the script executes, it can still use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
209 old value. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
210
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
211 :if !exists("s:call_count")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
212 : let s:call_count = 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
213 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
214 :let s:call_count = s:call_count + 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
215 :echo "called" s:call_count "times"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
216
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
217 The "exists()" function checks if a variable has already been defined. Its
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
218 argument is the name of the variable you want to check. Not the variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
219 itself! If you would do this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
220
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
221 :if !exists(s:call_count)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
222
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
223 Then the value of s:call_count will be used as the name of the variable that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
224 exists() checks. That's not what you want.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
225 The exclamation mark ! negates a value. When the value was true, it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
226 becomes false. When it was false, it becomes true. You can read it as "not".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
227 Thus "if !exists()" can be read as "if not exists()".
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
228 What Vim calls true is anything that is not zero. Zero is false.
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
229 Note:
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
230 Vim automatically converts a string to a number when it is looking for
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
231 a number. When using a string that doesn't start with a digit the
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
232 resulting number is zero. Thus look out for this: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
233 :if "true"
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
234 < The "true" will be interpreted as a zero, thus as false!
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
235
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
236
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
237 STRING VARIABLES AND CONSTANTS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
238
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
239 So far only numbers were used for the variable value. Strings can be used as
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
240 well. Numbers and strings are the basic types of variables that Vim supports.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
241 The type is dynamic, it is set each time when assigning a value to the
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
242 variable with ":let". More about types in |41.8|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
243 To assign a string value to a variable, you need to use a string constant.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
244 There are two types of these. First the string in double quotes: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
245
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
246 :let name = "peter"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
247 :echo name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
248 < peter ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
249
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
250 If you want to include a double quote inside the string, put a backslash in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
251 front of it: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
252
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
253 :let name = "\"peter\""
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
254 :echo name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
255 < "peter" ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
256
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
257 To avoid the need for a backslash, you can use a string in single quotes: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
258
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
259 :let name = '"peter"'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
260 :echo name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
261 < "peter" ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
262
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
263 Inside a single-quote string all the characters are as they are. Only the
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
264 single quote itself is special: you need to use two to get one. A backslash
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
265 is taken literally, thus you can't use it to change the meaning of the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
266 character after it.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
267 In double-quote strings it is possible to use special characters. Here are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
268 a few useful ones:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
269
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
270 \t <Tab>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
271 \n <NL>, line break
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
272 \r <CR>, <Enter>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
273 \e <Esc>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
274 \b <BS>, backspace
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
275 \" "
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
276 \\ \, backslash
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
277 \<Esc> <Esc>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
278 \<C-W> CTRL-W
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
279
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
280 The last two are just examples. The "\<name>" form can be used to include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
281 the special key "name".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
282 See |expr-quote| for the full list of special items in a string.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
283
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
284 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
285 *41.3* Expressions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
286
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
287 Vim has a rich, yet simple way to handle expressions. You can read the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
288 definition here: |expression-syntax|. Here we will show the most common
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
289 items.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
290 The numbers, strings and variables mentioned above are expressions by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
291 themselves. Thus everywhere an expression is expected, you can use a number,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
292 string or variable. Other basic items in an expression are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
293
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
294 $NAME environment variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
295 &name option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
296 @r register
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
297
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
298 Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
299
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
300 :echo "The value of 'tabstop' is" &ts
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
301 :echo "Your home directory is" $HOME
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
302 :if @a > 5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
303
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
304 The &name form can be used to save an option value, set it to a new value,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
305 do something and restore the old value. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
306
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
307 :let save_ic = &ic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
308 :set noic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
309 :/The Start/,$delete
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
310 :let &ic = save_ic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
311
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
312 This makes sure the "The Start" pattern is used with the 'ignorecase' option
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
313 off. Still, it keeps the value that the user had set. (Another way to do
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
314 this would be to add "\C" to the pattern, see |/\C|.)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
315
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
316
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
317 MATHEMATICS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
318
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
319 It becomes more interesting if we combine these basic items. Let's start with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
320 mathematics on numbers:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
321
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
322 a + b add
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
323 a - b subtract
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
324 a * b multiply
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
325 a / b divide
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
326 a % b modulo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
327
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
328 The usual precedence is used. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
329
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
330 :echo 10 + 5 * 2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
331 < 20 ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
332
2709
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
333 Grouping is done with parentheses. No surprises here. Example: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
334
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
335 :echo (10 + 5) * 2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
336 < 30 ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
337
22171
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
338 Strings can be concatenated with ".." (see |expr6|). Example: >
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
339
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
340 :echo "foo" .. "bar"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
341 < foobar ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
342
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
343 When the ":echo" command gets multiple arguments, it separates them with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
344 space. In the example the argument is a single expression, thus no space is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
345 inserted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
346
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
347 Borrowed from the C language is the conditional expression:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
348
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
349 a ? b : c
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
350
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
351 If "a" evaluates to true "b" is used, otherwise "c" is used. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
352
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
353 :let i = 4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
354 :echo i > 5 ? "i is big" : "i is small"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
355 < i is small ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
356
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
357 The three parts of the constructs are always evaluated first, thus you could
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
358 see it work as:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
359
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
360 (a) ? (b) : (c)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
361
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
362 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
363 *41.4* Conditionals
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
364
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
365 The ":if" commands executes the following statements, until the matching
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
366 ":endif", only when a condition is met. The generic form is:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
367
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
368 :if {condition}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
369 {statements}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
370 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
371
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
372 Only when the expression {condition} evaluates to true (non-zero) will the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
373 {statements} be executed. These must still be valid commands. If they
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
374 contain garbage, Vim won't be able to find the ":endif".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
375 You can also use ":else". The generic form for this is:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
376
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
377 :if {condition}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
378 {statements}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
379 :else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
380 {statements}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
381 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
382
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
383 The second {statements} is only executed if the first one isn't.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
384 Finally, there is ":elseif":
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
385
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
386 :if {condition}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
387 {statements}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
388 :elseif {condition}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
389 {statements}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
390 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
391
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
392 This works just like using ":else" and then "if", but without the need for an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
393 extra ":endif".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
394 A useful example for your vimrc file is checking the 'term' option and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
395 doing something depending upon its value: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
396
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
397 :if &term == "xterm"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
398 : " Do stuff for xterm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
399 :elseif &term == "vt100"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
400 : " Do stuff for a vt100 terminal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
401 :else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
402 : " Do something for other terminals
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
403 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
404
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
405
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
406 LOGIC OPERATIONS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
407
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
408 We already used some of them in the examples. These are the most often used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
409 ones:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
410
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
411 a == b equal to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
412 a != b not equal to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
413 a > b greater than
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
414 a >= b greater than or equal to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
415 a < b less than
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
416 a <= b less than or equal to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
417
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
418 The result is one if the condition is met and zero otherwise. An example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
419
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
420 :if v:version >= 700
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
421 : echo "congratulations"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
422 :else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
423 : echo "you are using an old version, upgrade!"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
424 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
425
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
426 Here "v:version" is a variable defined by Vim, which has the value of the Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
427 version. 600 is for version 6.0. Version 6.1 has the value 601. This is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
428 very useful to write a script that works with multiple versions of Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
429 |v:version|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
430
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
431 The logic operators work both for numbers and strings. When comparing two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
432 strings, the mathematical difference is used. This compares byte values,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
433 which may not be right for some languages.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
434 When comparing a string with a number, the string is first converted to a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
435 number. This is a bit tricky, because when a string doesn't look like a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
436 number, the number zero is used. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
437
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
438 :if 0 == "one"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
439 : echo "yes"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
440 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
441
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
442 This will echo "yes", because "one" doesn't look like a number, thus it is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
443 converted to the number zero.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
444
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
445 For strings there are two more items:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
446
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
447 a =~ b matches with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
448 a !~ b does not match with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
449
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
450 The left item "a" is used as a string. The right item "b" is used as a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
451 pattern, like what's used for searching. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
452
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
453 :if str =~ " "
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
454 : echo "str contains a space"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
455 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
456 :if str !~ '\.$'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
457 : echo "str does not end in a full stop"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
458 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
459
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
460 Notice the use of a single-quote string for the pattern. This is useful,
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
461 because backslashes would need to be doubled in a double-quote string and
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
462 patterns tend to contain many backslashes.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
463
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
464 The 'ignorecase' option is used when comparing strings. When you don't want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
465 that, append "#" to match case and "?" to ignore case. Thus "==?" compares
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
466 two strings to be equal while ignoring case. And "!~#" checks if a pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
467 doesn't match, also checking the case of letters. For the full table see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
468 |expr-==|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
469
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
470
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
471 MORE LOOPING
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
472
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
473 The ":while" command was already mentioned. Two more statements can be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
474 in between the ":while" and the ":endwhile":
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
475
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
476 :continue Jump back to the start of the while loop; the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
477 loop continues.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
478 :break Jump forward to the ":endwhile"; the loop is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
479 discontinued.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
480
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
481 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
482
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
483 :while counter < 40
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
484 : call do_something()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
485 : if skip_flag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
486 : continue
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
487 : endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
488 : if finished_flag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
489 : break
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
490 : endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
491 : sleep 50m
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
492 :endwhile
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
493
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
494 The ":sleep" command makes Vim take a nap. The "50m" specifies fifty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
495 milliseconds. Another example is ":sleep 4", which sleeps for four seconds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
496
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
497 Even more looping can be done with the ":for" command, see below in |41.8|.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
498
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
499 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
500 *41.5* Executing an expression
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
501
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
502 So far the commands in the script were executed by Vim directly. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
503 ":execute" command allows executing the result of an expression. This is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
504 very powerful way to build commands and execute them.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
505 An example is to jump to a tag, which is contained in a variable: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
506
22171
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
507 :execute "tag " .. tag_name
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
508
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
509 The ".." is used to concatenate the string "tag " with the value of variable
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
510 "tag_name". Suppose "tag_name" has the value "get_cmd", then the command that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
511 will be executed is: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
512
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
513 :tag get_cmd
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
514
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
515 The ":execute" command can only execute colon commands. The ":normal" command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
516 executes Normal mode commands. However, its argument is not an expression but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
517 the literal command characters. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
518
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
519 :normal gg=G
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
520
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
521 This jumps to the first line and formats all lines with the "=" operator.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
522 To make ":normal" work with an expression, combine ":execute" with it.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
523 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
524
22171
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
525 :execute "normal " .. normal_commands
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
526
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
527 The variable "normal_commands" must contain the Normal mode commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
528 Make sure that the argument for ":normal" is a complete command. Otherwise
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
529 Vim will run into the end of the argument and abort the command. For example,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
530 if you start Insert mode, you must leave Insert mode as well. This works: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
531
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
532 :execute "normal Inew text \<Esc>"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
533
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
534 This inserts "new text " in the current line. Notice the use of the special
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
535 key "\<Esc>". This avoids having to enter a real <Esc> character in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
536 script.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
537
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
538 If you don't want to execute a string but evaluate it to get its expression
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
539 value, you can use the eval() function: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
540
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
541 :let optname = "path"
22171
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
542 :let optval = eval('&' .. optname)
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
543
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
544 A "&" character is prepended to "path", thus the argument to eval() is
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
545 "&path". The result will then be the value of the 'path' option.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
546 The same thing can be done with: >
22171
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
547 :exe 'let optval = &' .. optname
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
548
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
549 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
550 *41.6* Using functions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
551
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
552 Vim defines many functions and provides a large amount of functionality that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
553 way. A few examples will be given in this section. You can find the whole
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
554 list here: |functions|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
555
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
556 A function is called with the ":call" command. The parameters are passed in
2709
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
557 between parentheses separated by commas. Example: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
558
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
559 :call search("Date: ", "W")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
560
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
561 This calls the search() function, with arguments "Date: " and "W". The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
562 search() function uses its first argument as a search pattern and the second
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
563 one as flags. The "W" flag means the search doesn't wrap around the end of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
564 the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
565
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
566 A function can be called in an expression. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
567
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
568 :let line = getline(".")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
569 :let repl = substitute(line, '\a', "*", "g")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
570 :call setline(".", repl)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
571
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
572 The getline() function obtains a line from the current buffer. Its argument
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
573 is a specification of the line number. In this case "." is used, which means
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
574 the line where the cursor is.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
575 The substitute() function does something similar to the ":substitute"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
576 command. The first argument is the string on which to perform the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
577 substitution. The second argument is the pattern, the third the replacement
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
578 string. Finally, the last arguments are the flags.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
579 The setline() function sets the line, specified by the first argument, to a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
580 new string, the second argument. In this example the line under the cursor is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
581 replaced with the result of the substitute(). Thus the effect of the three
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
582 statements is equal to: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
583
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
584 :substitute/\a/*/g
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
585
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
586 Using the functions becomes more interesting when you do more work before and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
587 after the substitute() call.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
588
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
589
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
590 FUNCTIONS *function-list*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
591
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
592 There are many functions. We will mention them here, grouped by what they are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
593 used for. You can find an alphabetical list here: |functions|. Use CTRL-] on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
594 the function name to jump to detailed help on it.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
595
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
596 String manipulation: *string-functions*
16235
219c58b3879c patch 8.1.1122: char2nr() does not handle composing characters
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16208
diff changeset
597 nr2char() get a character by its number value
219c58b3879c patch 8.1.1122: char2nr() does not handle composing characters
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16208
diff changeset
598 list2str() get a character string from a list of numbers
219c58b3879c patch 8.1.1122: char2nr() does not handle composing characters
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16208
diff changeset
599 char2nr() get number value of a character
219c58b3879c patch 8.1.1122: char2nr() does not handle composing characters
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16208
diff changeset
600 str2list() get list of numbers from a string
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
601 str2nr() convert a string to a Number
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
602 str2float() convert a string to a Float
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
603 printf() format a string according to % items
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
604 escape() escape characters in a string with a '\'
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
605 shellescape() escape a string for use with a shell command
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
606 fnameescape() escape a file name for use with a Vim command
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
607 tr() translate characters from one set to another
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
608 strtrans() translate a string to make it printable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
609 tolower() turn a string to lowercase
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
610 toupper() turn a string to uppercase
21973
85add08e6a2d patch 8.2.1536: cannot get the class of a character; emoji widths are wrong
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21971
diff changeset
611 charclass() class of a character
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
612 match() position where a pattern matches in a string
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
613 matchend() position where a pattern match ends in a string
22232
f22acf6472da patch 8.2.1665: cannot do fuzzy string matching
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22171
diff changeset
614 matchfuzzy() fuzzy matches a string in a list of strings
22355
0491b9cafd44 patch 8.2.1726: fuzzy matching only works on strings
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22232
diff changeset
615 matchfuzzypos() fuzzy matches a string in a list of strings
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
616 matchstr() match of a pattern in a string
9644
9f7bcc2c3b97 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/6f1d9a096bf22d50c727dca73abbfb8e3ff55176
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9464
diff changeset
617 matchstrpos() match and positions of a pattern in a string
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
618 matchlist() like matchstr() and also return submatches
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
619 stridx() first index of a short string in a long string
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
620 strridx() last index of a short string in a long string
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
621 strlen() length of a string in bytes
24130
c3d1f65365c4 patch 8.2.2606: strchars() defaults to counting composing characters
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23931
diff changeset
622 strcharlen() length of a string in characters
c3d1f65365c4 patch 8.2.2606: strchars() defaults to counting composing characters
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23931
diff changeset
623 strchars() number of characters in a string
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
624 strwidth() size of string when displayed
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
625 strdisplaywidth() size of string when displayed, deals with tabs
21971
0bc43a704f56 patch 8.2.1535: it is not possible to specify cell widths of characters
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21825
diff changeset
626 setcellwidths() set character cell width overrides
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
627 substitute() substitute a pattern match with a string
2908
fd09a9c8468e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2725
diff changeset
628 submatch() get a specific match in ":s" and substitute()
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
629 strpart() get part of a string using byte index
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
630 strcharpart() get part of a string using char index
23604
1816ea68c022 patch 8.2.2344: using inclusive index for slice is not always desired
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23602
diff changeset
631 slice() take a slice of a string, using char index in
1816ea68c022 patch 8.2.2344: using inclusive index for slice is not always desired
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23602
diff changeset
632 Vim9 script
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
633 strgetchar() get character from a string using char index
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
634 expand() expand special keywords
17020
1841c03a9b5e patch 8.1.1510: a plugin cannot easily expand a command like done internally
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16871
diff changeset
635 expandcmd() expand a command like done for `:edit`
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
636 iconv() convert text from one encoding to another
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
637 byteidx() byte index of a character in a string
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
638 byteidxcomp() like byteidx() but count composing characters
23380
2351b40af967 patch 8.2.2233: cannot convert a byte index into a character index
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23305
diff changeset
639 charidx() character index of a byte in a string
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
640 repeat() repeat a string multiple times
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
641 eval() evaluate a string expression
9464
be72f4201a1d commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/063b9d15abea041a5bfff3ffc4e219e26fd1d4fa
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9319
diff changeset
642 execute() execute an Ex command and get the output
16871
e5dab34ded73 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16808
diff changeset
643 win_execute() like execute() but in a specified window
15068
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
644 trim() trim characters from a string
21989
52e970719f4b patch 8.2.1544: cannot translate messages in a Vim script
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21973
diff changeset
645 gettext() lookup message translation
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
646
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
647 List manipulation: *list-functions*
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
648 get() get an item without error for wrong index
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
649 len() number of items in a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
650 empty() check if List is empty
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
651 insert() insert an item somewhere in a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
652 add() append an item to a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
653 extend() append a List to a List
23588
510088f8c66f patch 8.2.2336: Vim9: not possible to extend dictionary with different type
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23573
diff changeset
654 extendnew() make a new List and append items
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
655 remove() remove one or more items from a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
656 copy() make a shallow copy of a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
657 deepcopy() make a full copy of a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
658 filter() remove selected items from a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
659 map() change each List item
22844
36fc73078bce patch 8.2.1969: Vim9: map() may change the list or dict item type
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22355
diff changeset
660 mapnew() make a new List with changed items
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
661 reduce() reduce a List to a value
23604
1816ea68c022 patch 8.2.2344: using inclusive index for slice is not always desired
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23602
diff changeset
662 slice() take a slice of a List
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
663 sort() sort a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
664 reverse() reverse the order of a List
5763
c52a655d927d Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5618
diff changeset
665 uniq() remove copies of repeated adjacent items
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
666 split() split a String into a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
667 join() join List items into a String
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
668 range() return a List with a sequence of numbers
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
669 string() String representation of a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
670 call() call a function with List as arguments
323
03b3684919e3 updated for version 7.0084
vimboss
parents: 270
diff changeset
671 index() index of a value in a List
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
672 max() maximum value in a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
673 min() minimum value in a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
674 count() count number of times a value appears in a List
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
675 repeat() repeat a List multiple times
20766
821925509d8c patch 8.2.0935: flattening a list with existing code is slow
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20743
diff changeset
676 flatten() flatten a List
23816
525c9e218c69 patch 8.2.2449: Vim9: flatten() always changes the list type
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23666
diff changeset
677 flattennew() flatten a copy of a List
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
678
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
679 Dictionary manipulation: *dict-functions*
323
03b3684919e3 updated for version 7.0084
vimboss
parents: 270
diff changeset
680 get() get an entry without an error for a wrong key
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
681 len() number of entries in a Dictionary
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
682 has_key() check whether a key appears in a Dictionary
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
683 empty() check if Dictionary is empty
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
684 remove() remove an entry from a Dictionary
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
685 extend() add entries from one Dictionary to another
23588
510088f8c66f patch 8.2.2336: Vim9: not possible to extend dictionary with different type
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23573
diff changeset
686 extendnew() make a new Dictionary and append items
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
687 filter() remove selected entries from a Dictionary
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
688 map() change each Dictionary entry
22844
36fc73078bce patch 8.2.1969: Vim9: map() may change the list or dict item type
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22355
diff changeset
689 mapnew() make a new Dictionary with changed items
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
690 keys() get List of Dictionary keys
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
691 values() get List of Dictionary values
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
692 items() get List of Dictionary key-value pairs
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
693 copy() make a shallow copy of a Dictionary
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
694 deepcopy() make a full copy of a Dictionary
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
695 string() String representation of a Dictionary
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
696 max() maximum value in a Dictionary
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
697 min() minimum value in a Dictionary
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
698 count() count number of times a value appears
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
699
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
700 Floating point computation: *float-functions*
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
701 float2nr() convert Float to Number
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
702 abs() absolute value (also works for Number)
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
703 round() round off
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
704 ceil() round up
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
705 floor() round down
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
706 trunc() remove value after decimal point
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
707 fmod() remainder of division
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
708 exp() exponential
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
709 log() natural logarithm (logarithm to base e)
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
710 log10() logarithm to base 10
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
711 pow() value of x to the exponent y
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
712 sqrt() square root
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
713 sin() sine
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
714 cos() cosine
2725
6f63330ec225 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
715 tan() tangent
6f63330ec225 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
716 asin() arc sine
6f63330ec225 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
717 acos() arc cosine
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
718 atan() arc tangent
2725
6f63330ec225 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
719 atan2() arc tangent
6f63330ec225 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
720 sinh() hyperbolic sine
6f63330ec225 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
721 cosh() hyperbolic cosine
6f63330ec225 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
722 tanh() hyperbolic tangent
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
723 isinf() check for infinity
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
724 isnan() check for not a number
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
725
3237
91e53bcb7946 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
726 Other computation: *bitwise-function*
91e53bcb7946 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
727 and() bitwise AND
91e53bcb7946 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
728 invert() bitwise invert
91e53bcb7946 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
729 or() bitwise OR
91e53bcb7946 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
730 xor() bitwise XOR
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
731 sha256() SHA-256 hash
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
732 rand() get a pseudo-random number
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
733 srand() initialize seed used by rand()
3237
91e53bcb7946 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
734
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
735 Variables: *var-functions*
23594
d3e064f54890 patch 8.2.2339: cannot get the type of a value as a string
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23588
diff changeset
736 type() type of a variable as a number
d3e064f54890 patch 8.2.2339: cannot get the type of a value as a string
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23588
diff changeset
737 typename() type of a variable as text
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
738 islocked() check if a variable is locked
11062
1218c5353e2b Runtime file updates.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 10734
diff changeset
739 funcref() get a Funcref for a function reference
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
740 function() get a Funcref for a function name
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
741 getbufvar() get a variable value from a specific buffer
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
742 setbufvar() set a variable in a specific buffer
831
f24a95dae8ee updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
743 getwinvar() get a variable from specific window
2207
b17bbfa96fa0 Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
744 gettabvar() get a variable from specific tab page
831
f24a95dae8ee updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
745 gettabwinvar() get a variable from specific window & tab page
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
746 setwinvar() set a variable in a specific window
2207
b17bbfa96fa0 Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
747 settabvar() set a variable in a specific tab page
831
f24a95dae8ee updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
748 settabwinvar() set a variable in a specific window & tab page
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
749 garbagecollect() possibly free memory
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
750
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
751 Cursor and mark position: *cursor-functions* *mark-functions*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
752 col() column number of the cursor or a mark
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
753 virtcol() screen column of the cursor or a mark
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
754 line() line number of the cursor or mark
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
755 wincol() window column number of the cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
756 winline() window line number of the cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
757 cursor() position the cursor at a line/column
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
758 screencol() get screen column of the cursor
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
759 screenrow() get screen row of the cursor
17292
8a095d343c59 patch 8.1.1645: cannot use a popup window for a balloon
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17257
diff changeset
760 screenpos() screen row and col of a text character
5968
92751673cc37 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5942
diff changeset
761 getcurpos() get position of the cursor
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
762 getpos() get position of cursor, mark, etc.
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
763 setpos() set position of cursor, mark, etc.
20615
8eed1e9389bb patch 8.2.0861: cannot easily get all the current marks
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 19721
diff changeset
764 getmarklist() list of global/local marks
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
765 byte2line() get line number at a specific byte count
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
766 line2byte() byte count at a specific line
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
767 diff_filler() get the number of filler lines above a line
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
768 screenattr() get attribute at a screen line/row
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
769 screenchar() get character code at a screen line/row
16133
eb087f8a26a8 patch 8.1.1071: cannot get composing characters from the screen
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16127
diff changeset
770 screenchars() get character codes at a screen line/row
eb087f8a26a8 patch 8.1.1071: cannot get composing characters from the screen
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16127
diff changeset
771 screenstring() get string of characters at a screen line/row
23563
87671ccc6c6b patch 8.2.2324: not easy to get mark en cursor posotion by character count
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23380
diff changeset
772 charcol() character number of the cursor or a mark
87671ccc6c6b patch 8.2.2324: not easy to get mark en cursor posotion by character count
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23380
diff changeset
773 getcharpos() get character position of cursor, mark, etc.
87671ccc6c6b patch 8.2.2324: not easy to get mark en cursor posotion by character count
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23380
diff changeset
774 setcharpos() set character position of cursor, mark, etc.
87671ccc6c6b patch 8.2.2324: not easy to get mark en cursor posotion by character count
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23380
diff changeset
775 getcursorcharpos() get character position of the cursor
87671ccc6c6b patch 8.2.2324: not easy to get mark en cursor posotion by character count
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23380
diff changeset
776 setcursorcharpos() set character position of the cursor
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
777
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
778 Working with text in the current buffer: *text-functions*
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
779 getline() get a line or list of lines from the buffer
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
780 setline() replace a line in the buffer
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
781 append() append line or list of lines in the buffer
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
782 indent() indent of a specific line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
783 cindent() indent according to C indenting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
784 lispindent() indent according to Lisp indenting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
785 nextnonblank() find next non-blank line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
786 prevnonblank() find previous non-blank line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
787 search() find a match for a pattern
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 647
diff changeset
788 searchpos() find a match for a pattern
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
789 searchcount() get number of matches before/after the cursor
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
790 searchpair() find the other end of a start/skip/end
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 647
diff changeset
791 searchpairpos() find the other end of a start/skip/end
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
792 searchdecl() search for the declaration of a name
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
793 getcharsearch() return character search information
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
794 setcharsearch() set character search information
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
795
17257
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
796 Working with text in another buffer:
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
797 getbufline() get a list of lines from the specified buffer
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
798 setbufline() replace a line in the specified buffer
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
799 appendbufline() append a list of lines in the specified buffer
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
800 deletebufline() delete lines from a specified buffer
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
801
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
802 *system-functions* *file-functions*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
803 System functions and manipulation of files:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
804 glob() expand wildcards
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
805 globpath() expand wildcards in a number of directories
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
806 glob2regpat() convert a glob pattern into a search pattern
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
807 findfile() find a file in a list of directories
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
808 finddir() find a directory in a list of directories
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
809 resolve() find out where a shortcut points to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
810 fnamemodify() modify a file name
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
811 pathshorten() shorten directory names in a path
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
812 simplify() simplify a path without changing its meaning
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
813 executable() check if an executable program exists
5814
755931e042e4 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5763
diff changeset
814 exepath() full path of an executable program
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
815 filereadable() check if a file can be read
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
816 filewritable() check if a file can be written to
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
817 getfperm() get the permissions of a file
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
818 setfperm() set the permissions of a file
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
819 getftype() get the kind of a file
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
820 isdirectory() check if a directory exists
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
821 getfsize() get the size of a file
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
822 getcwd() get the current working directory
16427
8c3a1bd270bb patch 8.1.1218: cannot set a directory for a tab page
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16267
diff changeset
823 haslocaldir() check if current window used |:lcd| or |:tcd|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
824 tempname() get the name of a temporary file
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
825 mkdir() create a new directory
16576
bcc343175103 patch 8.1.1291: not easy to change directory and restore
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16517
diff changeset
826 chdir() change current working directory
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
827 delete() delete a file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
828 rename() rename a file
5814
755931e042e4 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5763
diff changeset
829 system() get the result of a shell command as a string
755931e042e4 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5763
diff changeset
830 systemlist() get the result of a shell command as a list
16604
1e0a5f09fdf1 patch 8.1.1305: there is no easy way to manipulate environment variables
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16576
diff changeset
831 environ() get all environment variables
1e0a5f09fdf1 patch 8.1.1305: there is no easy way to manipulate environment variables
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16576
diff changeset
832 getenv() get one environment variable
1e0a5f09fdf1 patch 8.1.1305: there is no easy way to manipulate environment variables
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16576
diff changeset
833 setenv() set an environment variable
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
834 hostname() name of the system
158
78423945b251 updated for version 7.0048
vimboss
parents: 129
diff changeset
835 readfile() read a file into a List of lines
23602
7b3317e959e3 patch 8.2.2343: Vim9: return type of readfile() is any
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23594
diff changeset
836 readblob() read a file into a Blob
16267
b471858040bc Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16235
diff changeset
837 readdir() get a List of file names in a directory
20643
c2beb6baa42c patch 8.2.0875: getting attributes for directory entries is slow
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20615
diff changeset
838 readdirex() get a List of file information in a directory
15729
fe57e4f0eac1 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15512
diff changeset
839 writefile() write a List of lines or Blob into a file
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
840
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
841 Date and Time: *date-functions* *time-functions*
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
842 getftime() get last modification time of a file
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
843 localtime() get current time in seconds
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
844 strftime() convert time to a string
18669
9007e9896303 patch 8.1.2326: cannot parse a date/time string
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 18639
diff changeset
845 strptime() convert a date/time string to time
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
846 reltime() get the current or elapsed time accurately
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
847 reltimestr() convert reltime() result to a string
8876
47f17f66da3d commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/03413f44167c4b5cd0012def9bb331e2518c83cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 8795
diff changeset
848 reltimefloat() convert reltime() result to a Float
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
849
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
850 *buffer-functions* *window-functions* *arg-functions*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
851 Buffers, windows and the argument list:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
852 argc() number of entries in the argument list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
853 argidx() current position in the argument list
5942
66eead134d68 updated for version 7.4.312
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5814
diff changeset
854 arglistid() get id of the argument list
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
855 argv() get one entry from the argument list
17257
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
856 bufadd() add a file to the list of buffers
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
857 bufexists() check if a buffer exists
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
858 buflisted() check if a buffer exists and is listed
17257
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
859 bufload() ensure a buffer is loaded
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
860 bufloaded() check if a buffer exists and is loaded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
861 bufname() get the name of a specific buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
862 bufnr() get the buffer number of a specific buffer
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
863 tabpagebuflist() return List of buffers in a tab page
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
864 tabpagenr() get the number of a tab page
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
865 tabpagewinnr() like winnr() for a specified tab page
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
866 winnr() get the window number for the current window
9227
ecb621205ed1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/82af8710bf8d1caeeceafb1370a052cb7d92f076
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 8876
diff changeset
867 bufwinid() get the window ID of a specific buffer
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
868 bufwinnr() get the window number of a specific buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
869 winbufnr() get the buffer number of a specific window
16638
4790302965fc patch 8.1.1321: no docs or tests for listener functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16610
diff changeset
870 listener_add() add a callback to listen to changes
16808
c002c4899529 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16638
diff changeset
871 listener_flush() invoke listener callbacks
16638
4790302965fc patch 8.1.1321: no docs or tests for listener functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16610
diff changeset
872 listener_remove() remove a listener callback
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
873 win_findbuf() find windows containing a buffer
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
874 win_getid() get window ID of a window
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
875 win_gettype() get type of window
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
876 win_gotoid() go to window with ID
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
877 win_id2tabwin() get tab and window nr from window ID
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
878 win_id2win() get window nr from window ID
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
879 win_splitmove() move window to a split of another window
9858
3e96d9ed2ca1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b5ae48e9ffd3b8eb6ca4057de11f1bddcde8ce6f
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9644
diff changeset
880 getbufinfo() get a list with buffer information
3e96d9ed2ca1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b5ae48e9ffd3b8eb6ca4057de11f1bddcde8ce6f
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9644
diff changeset
881 gettabinfo() get a list with tab page information
3e96d9ed2ca1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b5ae48e9ffd3b8eb6ca4057de11f1bddcde8ce6f
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9644
diff changeset
882 getwininfo() get a list with window information
13280
fbda23eb0996 patch 8.0.1514: getting the list of changes is not easy
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 13246
diff changeset
883 getchangelist() get a list of change list entries
13246
dd3b2ecf91f6 patch 8.0.1497: getting the jump list requires parsing the output of :jumps
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 13051
diff changeset
884 getjumplist() get a list of jump list entries
14637
0ecb909e3249 Update runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 14519
diff changeset
885 swapinfo() information about a swap file
15068
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
886 swapname() get the swap file path of a buffer
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
887
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
888 Command line: *command-line-functions*
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
889 getcmdline() get the current command line
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
890 getcmdpos() get position of the cursor in the command line
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
891 setcmdpos() set position of the cursor in the command line
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
892 getcmdtype() return the current command-line type
6153
1e8ebf870720 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5979
diff changeset
893 getcmdwintype() return the current command-line window type
9644
9f7bcc2c3b97 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/6f1d9a096bf22d50c727dca73abbfb8e3ff55176
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9464
diff changeset
894 getcompletion() list of command-line completion matches
23853
a9ed31ab85c3 patch 8.2.2468: not easy to get the full command name from a shortened one
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 23816
diff changeset
895 fullcommand() get full command name
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
896
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
897 Quickfix and location lists: *quickfix-functions*
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
898 getqflist() list of quickfix errors
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
899 setqflist() modify a quickfix list
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
900 getloclist() list of location list items
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
901 setloclist() modify a location list
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
902
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
903 Insert mode completion: *completion-functions*
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
904 complete() set found matches
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
905 complete_add() add to found matches
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
906 complete_check() check if completion should be aborted
16127
0375e54f0adc patch 8.1.1068: cannot get all the information about current completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15729
diff changeset
907 complete_info() get current completion information
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
908 pumvisible() check if the popup menu is displayed
18186
03b854983b14 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17372
diff changeset
909 pum_getpos() position and size of popup menu if visible
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
910
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
911 Folding: *folding-functions*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
912 foldclosed() check for a closed fold at a specific line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
913 foldclosedend() like foldclosed() but return the last line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
914 foldlevel() check for the fold level at a specific line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
915 foldtext() generate the line displayed for a closed fold
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
916 foldtextresult() get the text displayed for a closed fold
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
917
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
918 Syntax and highlighting: *syntax-functions* *highlighting-functions*
1326
22886f3d882d updated for version 7.1-040
vimboss
parents: 1252
diff changeset
919 clearmatches() clear all matches defined by |matchadd()| and
22886f3d882d updated for version 7.1-040
vimboss
parents: 1252
diff changeset
920 the |:match| commands
22886f3d882d updated for version 7.1-040
vimboss
parents: 1252
diff changeset
921 getmatches() get all matches defined by |matchadd()| and
22886f3d882d updated for version 7.1-040
vimboss
parents: 1252
diff changeset
922 the |:match| commands
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
923 hlexists() check if a highlight group exists
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
924 hlID() get ID of a highlight group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
925 synID() get syntax ID at a specific position
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
926 synIDattr() get a specific attribute of a syntax ID
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
927 synIDtrans() get translated syntax ID
2642
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2577
diff changeset
928 synstack() get list of syntax IDs at a specific position
2662
916c90b37ea9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
929 synconcealed() get info about concealing
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
930 diff_hlID() get highlight ID for diff mode at a position
1326
22886f3d882d updated for version 7.1-040
vimboss
parents: 1252
diff changeset
931 matchadd() define a pattern to highlight (a "match")
5979
f9fa2e506b9f updated for version 7.4.330
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5968
diff changeset
932 matchaddpos() define a list of positions to highlight
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
933 matcharg() get info about |:match| arguments
1326
22886f3d882d updated for version 7.1-040
vimboss
parents: 1252
diff changeset
934 matchdelete() delete a match defined by |matchadd()| or a
22886f3d882d updated for version 7.1-040
vimboss
parents: 1252
diff changeset
935 |:match| command
22886f3d882d updated for version 7.1-040
vimboss
parents: 1252
diff changeset
936 setmatches() restore a list of matches saved by
22886f3d882d updated for version 7.1-040
vimboss
parents: 1252
diff changeset
937 |getmatches()|
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
938
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
939 Spelling: *spell-functions*
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
940 spellbadword() locate badly spelled word at or after cursor
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
941 spellsuggest() return suggested spelling corrections
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
942 soundfold() return the sound-a-like equivalent of a word
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
943
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
944 History: *history-functions*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
945 histadd() add an item to a history
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
946 histdel() delete an item from a history
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
947 histget() get an item from a history
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
948 histnr() get highest index of a history list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
949
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
950 Interactive: *interactive-functions*
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
951 browse() put up a file requester
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
952 browsedir() put up a directory requester
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
953 confirm() let the user make a choice
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
954 getchar() get a character from the user
24840
c7aa7acb23bb patch 8.2.2958: function list test fails
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 24520
diff changeset
955 getcharstr() get a character from the user as a string
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
956 getcharmod() get modifiers for the last typed character
18639
cb3163d590a1 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 18186
diff changeset
957 getmousepos() get last known mouse position
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
958 echoraw() output characters as-is
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
959 feedkeys() put characters in the typeahead queue
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
960 input() get a line from the user
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
961 inputlist() let the user pick an entry from a list
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
962 inputsecret() get a line from the user without showing it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
963 inputdialog() get a line from the user in a dialog
230
9281a51ca7a2 updated for version 7.0064
vimboss
parents: 211
diff changeset
964 inputsave() save and clear typeahead
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
965 inputrestore() restore typeahead
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
966
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
967 GUI: *gui-functions*
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
968 getfontname() get name of current font being used
13437
02b3f719eacb Update runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 13341
diff changeset
969 getwinpos() position of the Vim window
02b3f719eacb Update runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 13341
diff changeset
970 getwinposx() X position of the Vim window
02b3f719eacb Update runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 13341
diff changeset
971 getwinposy() Y position of the Vim window
11062
1218c5353e2b Runtime file updates.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 10734
diff changeset
972 balloon_show() set the balloon content
12909
1578c0ba0dd1 Update runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 12756
diff changeset
973 balloon_split() split a message for a balloon
16604
1e0a5f09fdf1 patch 8.1.1305: there is no easy way to manipulate environment variables
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16576
diff changeset
974 balloon_gettext() get the text in the balloon
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
975
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
976 Vim server: *server-functions*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
977 serverlist() return the list of server names
12756
3b26420fc639 Long overdue runtime update.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 12254
diff changeset
978 remote_startserver() run a server
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
979 remote_send() send command characters to a Vim server
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
980 remote_expr() evaluate an expression in a Vim server
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
981 server2client() send a reply to a client of a Vim server
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
982 remote_peek() check if there is a reply from a Vim server
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
983 remote_read() read a reply from a Vim server
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
984 foreground() move the Vim window to the foreground
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
985 remote_foreground() move the Vim server window to the foreground
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
986
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
987 Window size and position: *window-size-functions*
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
988 winheight() get height of a specific window
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
989 winwidth() get width of a specific window
13051
a6d3e2081544 Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 12909
diff changeset
990 win_screenpos() get screen position of a window
15068
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
991 winlayout() get layout of windows in a tab page
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
992 winrestcmd() return command to restore window sizes
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
993 winsaveview() get view of current window
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
994 winrestview() restore saved view of current window
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
995
19657
da791e5c0139 patch 8.2.0385: menu functionality insufficiently tested
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 19384
diff changeset
996 Mappings and Menus: *mapping-functions*
4159
8b86b69546a9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3893
diff changeset
997 hasmapto() check if a mapping exists
8b86b69546a9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3893
diff changeset
998 mapcheck() check if a matching mapping exists
8b86b69546a9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3893
diff changeset
999 maparg() get rhs of a mapping
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1000 mapset() restore a mapping
19657
da791e5c0139 patch 8.2.0385: menu functionality insufficiently tested
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 19384
diff changeset
1001 menu_info() get information about a menu item
4159
8b86b69546a9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3893
diff changeset
1002 wildmenumode() check if the wildmode is active
8b86b69546a9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3893
diff changeset
1003
7279
b5e9810b389d commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/683fa185a4b4ed7595e5942901548b8239ed5cdb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 6153
diff changeset
1004 Testing: *test-functions*
8673
ed7251c3e2d3 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e18c0b39815c5a746887a509c2cd9f11fadaba07
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 8061
diff changeset
1005 assert_equal() assert that two expressions values are equal
15068
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1006 assert_equalfile() assert that two file contents are equal
8876
47f17f66da3d commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/03413f44167c4b5cd0012def9bb331e2518c83cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 8795
diff changeset
1007 assert_notequal() assert that two expressions values are not equal
9644
9f7bcc2c3b97 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/6f1d9a096bf22d50c727dca73abbfb8e3ff55176
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9464
diff changeset
1008 assert_inrange() assert that an expression is inside a range
8795
aba2d0a01290 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/7db8f6f4f85e5d0526d23107b2a5e2334dc23354
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 8793
diff changeset
1009 assert_match() assert that a pattern matches the value
8876
47f17f66da3d commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/03413f44167c4b5cd0012def9bb331e2518c83cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 8795
diff changeset
1010 assert_notmatch() assert that a pattern does not match the value
7279
b5e9810b389d commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/683fa185a4b4ed7595e5942901548b8239ed5cdb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 6153
diff changeset
1011 assert_false() assert that an expression is false
b5e9810b389d commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/683fa185a4b4ed7595e5942901548b8239ed5cdb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 6153
diff changeset
1012 assert_true() assert that an expression is true
8673
ed7251c3e2d3 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e18c0b39815c5a746887a509c2cd9f11fadaba07
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 8061
diff changeset
1013 assert_exception() assert that a command throws an exception
13341
acd7eaa13d2b Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 13280
diff changeset
1014 assert_beeps() assert that a command beeps
24313
10c39822f496 patch 8.2.2697: function list test fails
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 24278
diff changeset
1015 assert_nobeep() assert that a command does not cause a beep
13341
acd7eaa13d2b Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 13280
diff changeset
1016 assert_fails() assert that a command fails
11229
146a1e213b60 Update runtime files. Add Rust support.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11160
diff changeset
1017 assert_report() report a test failure
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1018 test_alloc_fail() make memory allocation fail
9644
9f7bcc2c3b97 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/6f1d9a096bf22d50c727dca73abbfb8e3ff55176
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9464
diff changeset
1019 test_autochdir() enable 'autochdir' during startup
11160
d0a20101ecb2 Update runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11062
diff changeset
1020 test_override() test with Vim internal overrides
d0a20101ecb2 Update runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11062
diff changeset
1021 test_garbagecollect_now() free memory right now
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1022 test_garbagecollect_soon() set a flag to free memory soon
16808
c002c4899529 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16638
diff changeset
1023 test_getvalue() get value of an internal variable
25006
496221916885 patch 8.2.3040: GUI: dropping files not tested
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 24982
diff changeset
1024 test_gui_drop_files() drop file(s) in a window
24982
4cb423b9250d patch 8.2.3028: GUI mouse events not tested
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 24911
diff changeset
1025 test_gui_mouse_event() add a GUI mouse event to the input buffer
11062
1218c5353e2b Runtime file updates.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 10734
diff changeset
1026 test_ignore_error() ignore a specific error message
15729
fe57e4f0eac1 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15512
diff changeset
1027 test_null_blob() return a null Blob
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1028 test_null_channel() return a null Channel
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1029 test_null_dict() return a null Dict
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1030 test_null_function() return a null Funcref
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1031 test_null_job() return a null Job
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1032 test_null_list() return a null List
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1033 test_null_partial() return a null Partial function
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1034 test_null_string() return a null String
11062
1218c5353e2b Runtime file updates.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 10734
diff changeset
1035 test_settime() set the time Vim uses internally
16517
9484fc00ac6b patch 8.1.1262: cannot simulate a mouse click in a test
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 16427
diff changeset
1036 test_setmouse() set the mouse position
15068
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1037 test_feedinput() add key sequence to input buffer
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1038 test_option_not_set() reset flag indicating option was set
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1039 test_scrollbar() simulate scrollbar movement in the GUI
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1040 test_refcount() return an expression's reference count
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1041 test_srand_seed() set the seed value for srand()
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1042 test_unknown() return a value with unknown type
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1043 test_void() return a value with void type
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1044
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1045 Inter-process communication: *channel-functions*
10449
222b1432814e commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 10198
diff changeset
1046 ch_canread() check if there is something to read
7924
00d64eb49ce1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/681baaf4a4c81418693dcafb81421a8614832e91
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7790
diff changeset
1047 ch_open() open a channel
00d64eb49ce1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/681baaf4a4c81418693dcafb81421a8614832e91
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7790
diff changeset
1048 ch_close() close a channel
10140
b11ceef7116e commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/64d8e25bf6efe5f18b032563521c3ce278c316ab
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9858
diff changeset
1049 ch_close_in() close the in part of a channel
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1050 ch_read() read a message from a channel
15512
f0f06837a699 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15418
diff changeset
1051 ch_readblob() read a Blob from a channel
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1052 ch_readraw() read a raw message from a channel
7924
00d64eb49ce1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/681baaf4a4c81418693dcafb81421a8614832e91
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7790
diff changeset
1053 ch_sendexpr() send a JSON message over a channel
00d64eb49ce1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/681baaf4a4c81418693dcafb81421a8614832e91
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7790
diff changeset
1054 ch_sendraw() send a raw message over a channel
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1055 ch_evalexpr() evaluate an expression over channel
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1056 ch_evalraw() evaluate a raw string over channel
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1057 ch_status() get status of a channel
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1058 ch_getbufnr() get the buffer number of a channel
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1059 ch_getjob() get the job associated with a channel
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1060 ch_info() get channel information
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1061 ch_log() write a message in the channel log file
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1062 ch_logfile() set the channel log file
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1063 ch_setoptions() set the options for a channel
9319
1472ed67c36f commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a02a551e18209423584fcb923e93c6be18f3aa45
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9286
diff changeset
1064 json_encode() encode an expression to a JSON string
1472ed67c36f commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a02a551e18209423584fcb923e93c6be18f3aa45
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9286
diff changeset
1065 json_decode() decode a JSON string to Vim types
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1066 js_encode() encode an expression to a JSON string
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1067 js_decode() decode a JSON string to Vim types
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1068
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1069 Jobs: *job-functions*
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1070 job_start() start a job
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1071 job_stop() stop a job
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1072 job_status() get the status of a job
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1073 job_getchannel() get the channel used by a job
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1074 job_info() get information about a job
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1075 job_setoptions() set options for a job
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1076
15209
3a99b2e6d136 patch 8.1.0614: placing signs can be complicated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15194
diff changeset
1077 Signs: *sign-functions*
3a99b2e6d136 patch 8.1.0614: placing signs can be complicated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15194
diff changeset
1078 sign_define() define or update a sign
3a99b2e6d136 patch 8.1.0614: placing signs can be complicated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15194
diff changeset
1079 sign_getdefined() get a list of defined signs
3a99b2e6d136 patch 8.1.0614: placing signs can be complicated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15194
diff changeset
1080 sign_getplaced() get a list of placed signs
15418
51b3c36b0523 patch 8.1.0717: there is no function for the ":sign jump" command
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15209
diff changeset
1081 sign_jump() jump to a sign
15209
3a99b2e6d136 patch 8.1.0614: placing signs can be complicated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15194
diff changeset
1082 sign_place() place a sign
17366
9843fbfa0ee5 patch 8.1.1682: placing a larger number of signs is slow
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17292
diff changeset
1083 sign_placelist() place a list of signs
15209
3a99b2e6d136 patch 8.1.0614: placing signs can be complicated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15194
diff changeset
1084 sign_undefine() undefine a sign
3a99b2e6d136 patch 8.1.0614: placing signs can be complicated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15194
diff changeset
1085 sign_unplace() unplace a sign
17366
9843fbfa0ee5 patch 8.1.1682: placing a larger number of signs is slow
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17292
diff changeset
1086 sign_unplacelist() unplace a list of signs
15209
3a99b2e6d136 patch 8.1.0614: placing signs can be complicated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15194
diff changeset
1087
12254
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
1088 Terminal window: *terminal-functions*
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
1089 term_start() open a terminal window and run a job
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
1090 term_list() get the list of terminal buffers
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
1091 term_sendkeys() send keystrokes to a terminal
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
1092 term_wait() wait for screen to be updated
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
1093 term_getjob() get the job associated with a terminal
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
1094 term_scrape() get row of a terminal screen
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
1095 term_getline() get a line of text from a terminal
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
1096 term_getattr() get the value of attribute {what}
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
1097 term_getcursor() get the cursor position of a terminal
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
1098 term_getscrolled() get the scroll count of a terminal
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
1099 term_getaltscreen() get the alternate screen flag
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
1100 term_getsize() get the size of a terminal
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
1101 term_getstatus() get the status of a terminal
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
1102 term_gettitle() get the title of a terminal
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
1103 term_gettty() get the tty name of a terminal
13735
a62eeee5f116 Update runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 13437
diff changeset
1104 term_setansicolors() set 16 ANSI colors, used for GUI
a62eeee5f116 Update runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 13437
diff changeset
1105 term_getansicolors() get 16 ANSI colors, used for GUI
15068
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1106 term_dumpdiff() display difference between two screen dumps
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1107 term_dumpload() load a terminal screen dump in a window
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1108 term_dumpwrite() dump contents of a terminal screen to a file
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1109 term_setkill() set signal to stop job in a terminal
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1110 term_setrestore() set command to restore a terminal
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1111 term_setsize() set the size of a terminal
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1112 term_setapi() set terminal JSON API function name prefix
12254
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
1113
17257
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
1114 Popup window: *popup-window-functions*
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
1115 popup_create() create popup centered in the screen
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
1116 popup_atcursor() create popup just above the cursor position,
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
1117 closes when the cursor moves away
17292
8a095d343c59 patch 8.1.1645: cannot use a popup window for a balloon
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17257
diff changeset
1118 popup_beval() at the position indicated by v:beval_
8a095d343c59 patch 8.1.1645: cannot use a popup window for a balloon
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17257
diff changeset
1119 variables, closes when the mouse moves away
17257
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
1120 popup_notification() show a notification for three seconds
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
1121 popup_dialog() create popup centered with padding and border
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
1122 popup_menu() prompt for selecting an item from a list
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
1123 popup_hide() hide a popup temporarily
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
1124 popup_show() show a previously hidden popup
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
1125 popup_move() change the position and size of a popup
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
1126 popup_setoptions() override options of a popup
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
1127 popup_settext() replace the popup buffer contents
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
1128 popup_close() close one popup
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
1129 popup_clear() close all popups
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
1130 popup_filter_menu() select from a list of items
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1131 popup_filter_yesno() block until 'y' or 'n' is pressed
17257
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
1132 popup_getoptions() get current options for a popup
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
1133 popup_getpos() get actual position and size of a popup
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1134 popup_findinfo() get window ID for popup info window
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1135 popup_findpreview() get window ID for popup preview window
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1136 popup_list() get list of all popup window IDs
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1137 popup_locate() get popup window ID from its screen position
17257
cb0ca75f0c26 patch 8.1.1628: popup window functions not in list of functions
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 17020
diff changeset
1138
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1139 Timers: *timer-functions*
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1140 timer_start() create a timer
9858
3e96d9ed2ca1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b5ae48e9ffd3b8eb6ca4057de11f1bddcde8ce6f
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9644
diff changeset
1141 timer_pause() pause or unpause a timer
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1142 timer_stop() stop a timer
9858
3e96d9ed2ca1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b5ae48e9ffd3b8eb6ca4057de11f1bddcde8ce6f
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9644
diff changeset
1143 timer_stopall() stop all timers
3e96d9ed2ca1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b5ae48e9ffd3b8eb6ca4057de11f1bddcde8ce6f
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9644
diff changeset
1144 timer_info() get information about timers
7790
ca19726d5e83 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/298b440930ecece38d6ea0505a3e582dc817e79b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7651
diff changeset
1145
15068
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1146 Tags: *tag-functions*
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1147 taglist() get list of matching tags
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1148 tagfiles() get a list of tags files
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1149 gettagstack() get the tag stack of a window
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1150 settagstack() modify the tag stack of a window
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1151
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1152 Prompt Buffer: *promptbuffer-functions*
22077
335365fcbb60 patch 8.2.1588: cannot read back the prompt of a prompt buffer
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21991
diff changeset
1153 prompt_getprompt() get the effective prompt text for a buffer
15068
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1154 prompt_setcallback() set prompt callback for a buffer
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1155 prompt_setinterrupt() set interrupt callback for a buffer
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1156 prompt_setprompt() set the prompt text for a buffer
d9d97b8afe0d Update runtime files
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15016
diff changeset
1157
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1158 Text Properties: *text-property-functions*
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1159 prop_add() attach a property at a position
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1160 prop_clear() remove all properties from a line or lines
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1161 prop_find() search for a property
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1162 prop_list() return a list of all properties in a line
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1163 prop_remove() remove a property from a line
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1164 prop_type_add() add/define a property type
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1165 prop_type_change() change properties of a type
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1166 prop_type_delete() remove a text property type
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1167 prop_type_get() return the properties of a type
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1168 prop_type_list() return a list of all property types
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1169
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1170 Sound: *sound-functions*
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1171 sound_clear() stop playing all sounds
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1172 sound_playevent() play an event's sound
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1173 sound_playfile() play a sound file
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1174 sound_stop() stop playing a sound
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1175
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
1176 Various: *various-functions*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1177 mode() get current editing mode
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1178 state() get current busy state
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1179 visualmode() last visual mode used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1180 exists() check if a variable, function, etc. exists
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1181 has() check if a feature is supported in Vim
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
1182 changenr() return number of most recent change
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1183 cscope_connection() check if a cscope connection exists
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1184 did_filetype() check if a FileType autocommand was used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1185 eventhandler() check if invoked by an event handler
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
1186 getpid() get process ID of Vim
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1187 getimstatus() check if IME status is active
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1188 interrupt() interrupt script execution
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1189 windowsversion() get MS-Windows version
20836
2616c5a337e0 patch 8.2.0970: terminal properties are not available in Vim script
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20766
diff changeset
1190 terminalprops() properties of the terminal
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
1191
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1192 libcall() call a function in an external library
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1193 libcallnr() idem, returning a number
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
1194
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
1195 undofile() get the name of the undo file
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
1196 undotree() return the state of the undo tree
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
1197
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1198 getreg() get contents of a register
20743
a672feb8fc4f patch 8.2.0924: cannot save and restore a register properly
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20687
diff changeset
1199 getreginfo() get information about a register
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1200 getregtype() get type of a register
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1201 setreg() set contents and type of a register
14004
e124262d435e patch 8.1.0020: cannot tell whether a register is executing or recording
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 13963
diff changeset
1202 reg_executing() return the name of the register being executed
e124262d435e patch 8.1.0020: cannot tell whether a register is executing or recording
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 13963
diff changeset
1203 reg_recording() return the name of the register being recorded
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
1204
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
1205 shiftwidth() effective value of 'shiftwidth'
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
1206
9464
be72f4201a1d commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/063b9d15abea041a5bfff3ffc4e219e26fd1d4fa
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9319
diff changeset
1207 wordcount() get byte/word/char count of buffer
be72f4201a1d commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/063b9d15abea041a5bfff3ffc4e219e26fd1d4fa
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9319
diff changeset
1208
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1209 luaeval() evaluate |Lua| expression
2050
afcf9db31561 updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
1210 mzeval() evaluate |MzScheme| expression
7651
c7575b07de98 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e9b892ebcd8596bf813793a1eed5a460a9495a28
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7480
diff changeset
1211 perleval() evaluate Perl expression (|+perl|)
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
1212 py3eval() evaluate Python expression (|+python3|)
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
1213 pyeval() evaluate Python expression (|+python|)
10734
523cd59d6db0 Update runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 10449
diff changeset
1214 pyxeval() evaluate |python_x| expression
20687
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1215 rubyeval() evaluate |Ruby| expression
770a8e9c4781 patch 8.2.0897: list of functions in patched version is outdated
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 20643
diff changeset
1216
15194
8b334e4cb97f Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 15068
diff changeset
1217 debugbreak() interrupt a program being debugged
2050
afcf9db31561 updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
1218
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1219 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1220 *41.7* Defining a function
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1221
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1222 Vim enables you to define your own functions. The basic function declaration
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1223 begins as follows: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1224
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1225 :function {name}({var1}, {var2}, ...)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1226 : {body}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1227 :endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1228 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1229 Note:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1230 Function names must begin with a capital letter.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1231
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1232 Let's define a short function to return the smaller of two numbers. It starts
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1233 with this line: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1234
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1235 :function Min(num1, num2)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1236
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1237 This tells Vim that the function is named "Min" and it takes two arguments:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1238 "num1" and "num2".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1239 The first thing you need to do is to check to see which number is smaller:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1240 >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1241 : if a:num1 < a:num2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1242
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1243 The special prefix "a:" tells Vim that the variable is a function argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1244 Let's assign the variable "smaller" the value of the smallest number: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1245
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1246 : if a:num1 < a:num2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1247 : let smaller = a:num1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1248 : else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1249 : let smaller = a:num2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1250 : endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1251
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1252 The variable "smaller" is a local variable. Variables used inside a function
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1253 are local unless prefixed by something like "g:", "a:", or "s:".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1254
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1255 Note:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1256 To access a global variable from inside a function you must prepend
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
1257 "g:" to it. Thus "g:today" inside a function is used for the global
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
1258 variable "today", and "today" is another variable, local to the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1259 function.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1260
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1261 You now use the ":return" statement to return the smallest number to the user.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1262 Finally, you end the function: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1263
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1264 : return smaller
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1265 :endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1266
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1267 The complete function definition is as follows: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1268
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1269 :function Min(num1, num2)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1270 : if a:num1 < a:num2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1271 : let smaller = a:num1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1272 : else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1273 : let smaller = a:num2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1274 : endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1275 : return smaller
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1276 :endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1277
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1278 For people who like short functions, this does the same thing: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1279
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1280 :function Min(num1, num2)
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1281 : if a:num1 < a:num2
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1282 : return a:num1
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1283 : endif
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1284 : return a:num2
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1285 :endfunction
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1286
681
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 667
diff changeset
1287 A user defined function is called in exactly the same way as a built-in
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1288 function. Only the name is different. The Min function can be used like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1289 this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1290
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1291 :echo Min(5, 8)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1292
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1293 Only now will the function be executed and the lines be interpreted by Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1294 If there are mistakes, like using an undefined variable or function, you will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1295 now get an error message. When defining the function these errors are not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1296 detected.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1297
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1298 When a function reaches ":endfunction" or ":return" is used without an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1299 argument, the function returns zero.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1300
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1301 To redefine a function that already exists, use the ! for the ":function"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1302 command: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1303
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1304 :function! Min(num1, num2, num3)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1305
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1306
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1307 USING A RANGE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1308
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1309 The ":call" command can be given a line range. This can have one of two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1310 meanings. When a function has been defined with the "range" keyword, it will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1311 take care of the line range itself.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1312 The function will be passed the variables "a:firstline" and "a:lastline".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1313 These will have the line numbers from the range the function was called with.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1314 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1315
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1316 :function Count_words() range
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
1317 : let lnum = a:firstline
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
1318 : let n = 0
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
1319 : while lnum <= a:lastline
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
1320 : let n = n + len(split(getline(lnum)))
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
1321 : let lnum = lnum + 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1322 : endwhile
22171
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
1323 : echo "found " .. n .. " words"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1324 :endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1325
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1326 You can call this function with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1327
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1328 :10,30call Count_words()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1329
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1330 It will be executed once and echo the number of words.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1331 The other way to use a line range is by defining a function without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1332 "range" keyword. The function will be called once for every line in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1333 range, with the cursor in that line. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1334
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1335 :function Number()
22171
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
1336 : echo "line " .. line(".") .. " contains: " .. getline(".")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1337 :endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1338
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1339 If you call this function with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1340
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1341 :10,15call Number()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1342
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1343 The function will be called six times.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1344
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1345
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1346 VARIABLE NUMBER OF ARGUMENTS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1347
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1348 Vim enables you to define functions that have a variable number of arguments.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1349 The following command, for instance, defines a function that must have 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1350 argument (start) and can have up to 20 additional arguments: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1351
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1352 :function Show(start, ...)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1353
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1354 The variable "a:1" contains the first optional argument, "a:2" the second, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1355 so on. The variable "a:0" contains the number of extra arguments.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1356 For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1357
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1358 :function Show(start, ...)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1359 : echohl Title
22171
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
1360 : echo "start is " .. a:start
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1361 : echohl None
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1362 : let index = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1363 : while index <= a:0
22171
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
1364 : echo " Arg " .. index .. " is " .. a:{index}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1365 : let index = index + 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1366 : endwhile
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1367 : echo ""
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1368 :endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1369
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1370 This uses the ":echohl" command to specify the highlighting used for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1371 following ":echo" command. ":echohl None" stops it again. The ":echon"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1372 command works like ":echo", but doesn't output a line break.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1373
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1374 You can also use the a:000 variable, it is a List of all the "..." arguments.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1375 See |a:000|.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1376
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1377
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1378 LISTING FUNCTIONS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1379
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1380 The ":function" command lists the names and arguments of all user-defined
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1381 functions: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1382
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1383 :function
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1384 < function Show(start, ...) ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1385 function GetVimIndent() ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1386 function SetSyn(name) ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1387
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1388 To see what a function does, use its name as an argument for ":function": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1389
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1390 :function SetSyn
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1391 < 1 if &syntax == '' ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1392 2 let &syntax = a:name ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1393 3 endif ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1394 endfunction ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1395
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1396
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1397 DEBUGGING
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1398
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1399 The line number is useful for when you get an error message or when debugging.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1400 See |debug-scripts| about debugging mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1401 You can also set the 'verbose' option to 12 or higher to see all function
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1402 calls. Set it to 15 or higher to see every executed line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1403
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1404
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1405 DELETING A FUNCTION
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1406
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1407 To delete the Show() function: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1408
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1409 :delfunction Show
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1410
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1411 You get an error when the function doesn't exist.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1412
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1413
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1414 FUNCTION REFERENCES
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1415
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1416 Sometimes it can be useful to have a variable point to one function or
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1417 another. You can do it with the function() function. It turns the name of a
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1418 function into a reference: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1419
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1420 :let result = 0 " or 1
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1421 :function! Right()
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1422 : return 'Right!'
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1423 :endfunc
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1424 :function! Wrong()
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1425 : return 'Wrong!'
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1426 :endfunc
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1427 :
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1428 :if result == 1
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1429 : let Afunc = function('Right')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1430 :else
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1431 : let Afunc = function('Wrong')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1432 :endif
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1433 :echo call(Afunc, [])
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1434 < Wrong! ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1435
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1436 Note that the name of a variable that holds a function reference must start
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1437 with a capital. Otherwise it could be confused with the name of a builtin
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1438 function.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1439 The way to invoke a function that a variable refers to is with the call()
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1440 function. Its first argument is the function reference, the second argument
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1441 is a List with arguments.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1442
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1443 Function references are most useful in combination with a Dictionary, as is
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1444 explained in the next section.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1445
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1446 ==============================================================================
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1447 *41.8* Lists and Dictionaries
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1448
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1449 So far we have used the basic types String and Number. Vim also supports two
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1450 composite types: List and Dictionary.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1451
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1452 A List is an ordered sequence of things. The things can be any kind of value,
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1453 thus you can make a List of numbers, a List of Lists and even a List of mixed
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1454 items. To create a List with three strings: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1455
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1456 :let alist = ['aap', 'mies', 'noot']
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1457
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1458 The List items are enclosed in square brackets and separated by commas. To
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1459 create an empty List: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1460
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1461 :let alist = []
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1462
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1463 You can add items to a List with the add() function: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1464
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1465 :let alist = []
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1466 :call add(alist, 'foo')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1467 :call add(alist, 'bar')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1468 :echo alist
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1469 < ['foo', 'bar'] ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1470
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1471 List concatenation is done with +: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1472
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1473 :echo alist + ['foo', 'bar']
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1474 < ['foo', 'bar', 'foo', 'bar'] ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1475
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1476 Or, if you want to extend a List directly: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1477
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1478 :let alist = ['one']
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1479 :call extend(alist, ['two', 'three'])
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1480 :echo alist
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1481 < ['one', 'two', 'three'] ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1482
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1483 Notice that using add() will have a different effect: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1484
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1485 :let alist = ['one']
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1486 :call add(alist, ['two', 'three'])
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1487 :echo alist
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1488 < ['one', ['two', 'three']] ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1489
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1490 The second argument of add() is added as a single item.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1491
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1492
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1493 FOR LOOP
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1494
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1495 One of the nice things you can do with a List is iterate over it: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1496
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1497 :let alist = ['one', 'two', 'three']
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1498 :for n in alist
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1499 : echo n
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1500 :endfor
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1501 < one ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1502 two ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1503 three ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1504
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1505 This will loop over each element in List "alist", assigning the value to
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1506 variable "n". The generic form of a for loop is: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1507
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1508 :for {varname} in {listexpression}
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1509 : {commands}
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1510 :endfor
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1511
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1512 To loop a certain number of times you need a List of a specific length. The
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1513 range() function creates one for you: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1514
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1515 :for a in range(3)
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1516 : echo a
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1517 :endfor
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1518 < 0 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1519 1 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1520 2 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1521
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1522 Notice that the first item of the List that range() produces is zero, thus the
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1523 last item is one less than the length of the list.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1524 You can also specify the maximum value, the stride and even go backwards: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1525
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1526 :for a in range(8, 4, -2)
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1527 : echo a
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1528 :endfor
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1529 < 8 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1530 6 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1531 4 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1532
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1533 A more useful example, looping over lines in the buffer: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1534
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1535 :for line in getline(1, 20)
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1536 : if line =~ "Date: "
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1537 : echo matchstr(line, 'Date: \zs.*')
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1538 : endif
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1539 :endfor
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1540
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1541 This looks into lines 1 to 20 (inclusive) and echoes any date found in there.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1542
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1543
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1544 DICTIONARIES
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1545
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1546 A Dictionary stores key-value pairs. You can quickly lookup a value if you
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1547 know the key. A Dictionary is created with curly braces: >
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1548
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1549 :let uk2nl = {'one': 'een', 'two': 'twee', 'three': 'drie'}
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1550
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1551 Now you can lookup words by putting the key in square brackets: >
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1552
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1553 :echo uk2nl['two']
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1554 < twee ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1555
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1556 The generic form for defining a Dictionary is: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1557
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1558 {<key> : <value>, ...}
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1559
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1560 An empty Dictionary is one without any keys: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1561
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1562 {}
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1563
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1564 The possibilities with Dictionaries are numerous. There are various functions
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1565 for them as well. For example, you can obtain a list of the keys and loop
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1566 over them: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1567
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1568 :for key in keys(uk2nl)
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1569 : echo key
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1570 :endfor
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1571 < three ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1572 one ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1573 two ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1574
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
1575 You will notice the keys are not ordered. You can sort the list to get a
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1576 specific order: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1577
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1578 :for key in sort(keys(uk2nl))
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1579 : echo key
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1580 :endfor
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1581 < one ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1582 three ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1583 two ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1584
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1585 But you can never get back the order in which items are defined. For that you
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1586 need to use a List, it stores items in an ordered sequence.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1587
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1588
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1589 DICTIONARY FUNCTIONS
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1590
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1591 The items in a Dictionary can normally be obtained with an index in square
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1592 brackets: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1593
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1594 :echo uk2nl['one']
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1595 < een ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1596
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1597 A method that does the same, but without so many punctuation characters: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1598
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1599 :echo uk2nl.one
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1600 < een ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1601
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1602 This only works for a key that is made of ASCII letters, digits and the
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1603 underscore. You can also assign a new value this way: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1604
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1605 :let uk2nl.four = 'vier'
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1606 :echo uk2nl
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1607 < {'three': 'drie', 'four': 'vier', 'one': 'een', 'two': 'twee'} ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1608
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1609 And now for something special: you can directly define a function and store a
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1610 reference to it in the dictionary: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1611
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1612 :function uk2nl.translate(line) dict
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1613 : return join(map(split(a:line), 'get(self, v:val, "???")'))
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1614 :endfunction
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1615
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1616 Let's first try it out: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1617
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1618 :echo uk2nl.translate('three two five one')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1619 < drie twee ??? een ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1620
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1621 The first special thing you notice is the "dict" at the end of the ":function"
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1622 line. This marks the function as being used from a Dictionary. The "self"
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1623 local variable will then refer to that Dictionary.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1624 Now let's break up the complicated return command: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1625
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1626 split(a:line)
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1627
2709
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
1628 The split() function takes a string, chops it into whitespace separated words
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1629 and returns a list with these words. Thus in the example it returns: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1630
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1631 :echo split('three two five one')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1632 < ['three', 'two', 'five', 'one'] ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1633
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1634 This list is the first argument to the map() function. This will go through
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1635 the list, evaluating its second argument with "v:val" set to the value of each
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1636 item. This is a shortcut to using a for loop. This command: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1637
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1638 :let alist = map(split(a:line), 'get(self, v:val, "???")')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1639
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1640 Is equivalent to: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1641
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1642 :let alist = split(a:line)
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1643 :for idx in range(len(alist))
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1644 : let alist[idx] = get(self, alist[idx], "???")
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1645 :endfor
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1646
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1647 The get() function checks if a key is present in a Dictionary. If it is, then
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1648 the value is retrieved. If it isn't, then the default value is returned, in
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1649 the example it's '???'. This is a convenient way to handle situations where a
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1650 key may not be present and you don't want an error message.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1651
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1652 The join() function does the opposite of split(): it joins together a list of
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1653 words, putting a space in between.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1654 This combination of split(), map() and join() is a nice way to filter a line
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1655 of words in a very compact way.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1656
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1657
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1658 OBJECT ORIENTED PROGRAMMING
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1659
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1660 Now that you can put both values and functions in a Dictionary, you can
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1661 actually use a Dictionary like an object.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1662 Above we used a Dictionary for translating Dutch to English. We might want
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1663 to do the same for other languages. Let's first make an object (aka
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1664 Dictionary) that has the translate function, but no words to translate: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1665
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1666 :let transdict = {}
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1667 :function transdict.translate(line) dict
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1668 : return join(map(split(a:line), 'get(self.words, v:val, "???")'))
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1669 :endfunction
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1670
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1671 It's slightly different from the function above, using 'self.words' to lookup
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1672 word translations. But we don't have a self.words. Thus you could call this
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1673 an abstract class.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1674
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1675 Now we can instantiate a Dutch translation object: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1676
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1677 :let uk2nl = copy(transdict)
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1678 :let uk2nl.words = {'one': 'een', 'two': 'twee', 'three': 'drie'}
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1679 :echo uk2nl.translate('three one')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1680 < drie een ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1681
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1682 And a German translator: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1683
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1684 :let uk2de = copy(transdict)
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1685 :let uk2de.words = {'one': 'eins', 'two': 'zwei', 'three': 'drei'}
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1686 :echo uk2de.translate('three one')
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1687 < drei eins ~
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1688
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1689 You see that the copy() function is used to make a copy of the "transdict"
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1690 Dictionary and then the copy is changed to add the words. The original
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1691 remains the same, of course.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1692
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1693 Now you can go one step further, and use your preferred translator: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1694
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1695 :if $LANG =~ "de"
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1696 : let trans = uk2de
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1697 :else
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1698 : let trans = uk2nl
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1699 :endif
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1700 :echo trans.translate('one two three')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1701 < een twee drie ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1702
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1703 Here "trans" refers to one of the two objects (Dictionaries). No copy is
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1704 made. More about List and Dictionary identity can be found at |list-identity|
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1705 and |dict-identity|.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1706
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1707 Now you might use a language that isn't supported. You can overrule the
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1708 translate() function to do nothing: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1709
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1710 :let uk2uk = copy(transdict)
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1711 :function! uk2uk.translate(line)
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1712 : return a:line
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1713 :endfunction
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1714 :echo uk2uk.translate('three one wladiwostok')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1715 < three one wladiwostok ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1716
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1717 Notice that a ! was used to overwrite the existing function reference. Now
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1718 use "uk2uk" when no recognized language is found: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1719
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1720 :if $LANG =~ "de"
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1721 : let trans = uk2de
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1722 :elseif $LANG =~ "nl"
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1723 : let trans = uk2nl
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1724 :else
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1725 : let trans = uk2uk
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1726 :endif
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1727 :echo trans.translate('one two three')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1728 < one two three ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1729
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1730 For further reading see |Lists| and |Dictionaries|.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1731
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1732 ==============================================================================
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1733 *41.9* Exceptions
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1734
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1735 Let's start with an example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1736
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1737 :try
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1738 : read ~/templates/pascal.tmpl
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1739 :catch /E484:/
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1740 : echo "Sorry, the Pascal template file cannot be found."
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1741 :endtry
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1742
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1743 The ":read" command will fail if the file does not exist. Instead of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1744 generating an error message, this code catches the error and gives the user a
2709
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
1745 nice message.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1746
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1747 For the commands in between ":try" and ":endtry" errors are turned into
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1748 exceptions. An exception is a string. In the case of an error the string
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1749 contains the error message. And every error message has a number. In this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1750 case, the error we catch contains "E484:". This number is guaranteed to stay
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1751 the same (the text may change, e.g., it may be translated).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1752
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1753 When the ":read" command causes another error, the pattern "E484:" will not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1754 match in it. Thus this exception will not be caught and result in the usual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1755 error message.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1756
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1757 You might be tempted to do this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1758
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1759 :try
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1760 : read ~/templates/pascal.tmpl
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1761 :catch
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1762 : echo "Sorry, the Pascal template file cannot be found."
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1763 :endtry
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1764
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1765 This means all errors are caught. But then you will not see errors that are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1766 useful, such as "E21: Cannot make changes, 'modifiable' is off".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1767
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1768 Another useful mechanism is the ":finally" command: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1769
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1770 :let tmp = tempname()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1771 :try
22171
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
1772 : exe ".,$write " .. tmp
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
1773 : exe "!filter " .. tmp
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1774 : .,$delete
22171
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
1775 : exe "$read " .. tmp
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1776 :finally
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1777 : call delete(tmp)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1778 :endtry
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1779
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1780 This filters the lines from the cursor until the end of the file through the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1781 "filter" command, which takes a file name argument. No matter if the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1782 filtering works, something goes wrong in between ":try" and ":finally" or the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1783 user cancels the filtering by pressing CTRL-C, the "call delete(tmp)" is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1784 always executed. This makes sure you don't leave the temporary file behind.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1785
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1786 More information about exception handling can be found in the reference
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1787 manual: |exception-handling|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1788
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1789 ==============================================================================
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1790 *41.10* Various remarks
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1791
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1792 Here is a summary of items that apply to Vim scripts. They are also mentioned
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1793 elsewhere, but form a nice checklist.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1794
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1795 The end-of-line character depends on the system. For Unix a single <NL>
23305
fab58304f77d Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22958
diff changeset
1796 character is used. For MS-Windows and the like, <CR><NL> is used. This is
18912
ccd16426a1f9 patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 18879
diff changeset
1797 important when using mappings that end in a <CR>. See |:source_crnl|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1798
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1799
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1800 WHITE SPACE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1801
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1802 Blank lines are allowed and ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1803
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1804 Leading whitespace characters (blanks and TABs) are always ignored. The
11062
1218c5353e2b Runtime file updates.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 10734
diff changeset
1805 whitespaces between parameters (e.g. between the "set" and the "cpoptions" in
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1806 the example below) are reduced to one blank character and plays the role of a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1807 separator, the whitespaces after the last (visible) character may or may not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1808 be ignored depending on the situation, see below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1809
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1810 For a ":set" command involving the "=" (equal) sign, such as in: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1811
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1812 :set cpoptions =aABceFst
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1813
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1814 the whitespace immediately before the "=" sign is ignored. But there can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1815 no whitespace after the "=" sign!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1816
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1817 To include a whitespace character in the value of an option, it must be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1818 escaped by a "\" (backslash) as in the following example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1819
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1820 :set tags=my\ nice\ file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1821
2709
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
1822 The same example written as: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1823
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1824 :set tags=my nice file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1825
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1826 will issue an error, because it is interpreted as: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1827
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1828 :set tags=my
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1829 :set nice
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1830 :set file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1831
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1832
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1833 COMMENTS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1834
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1835 The character " (the double quote mark) starts a comment. Everything after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1836 and including this character until the end-of-line is considered a comment and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1837 is ignored, except for commands that don't consider comments, as shown in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1838 examples below. A comment can start on any character position on the line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1839
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1840 There is a little "catch" with comments for some commands. Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1841
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1842 :abbrev dev development " shorthand
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1843 :map <F3> o#include " insert include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1844 :execute cmd " do it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1845 :!ls *.c " list C files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1846
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1847 The abbreviation 'dev' will be expanded to 'development " shorthand'. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1848 mapping of <F3> will actually be the whole line after the 'o# ....' including
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1849 the '" insert include'. The "execute" command will give an error. The "!"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1850 command will send everything after it to the shell, causing an error for an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1851 unmatched '"' character.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1852 There can be no comment after ":map", ":abbreviate", ":execute" and "!"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1853 commands (there are a few more commands with this restriction). For the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1854 ":map", ":abbreviate" and ":execute" commands there is a trick: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1855
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1856 :abbrev dev development|" shorthand
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1857 :map <F3> o#include|" insert include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1858 :execute cmd |" do it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1859
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1860 With the '|' character the command is separated from the next one. And that
1146
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1861 next command is only a comment. For the last command you need to do two
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1862 things: |:execute| and use '|': >
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1863 :exe '!ls *.c' |" list C files
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1864
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1865 Notice that there is no white space before the '|' in the abbreviation and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1866 mapping. For these commands, any character until the end-of-line or '|' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1867 included. As a consequence of this behavior, you don't always see that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1868 trailing whitespace is included: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1869
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1870 :map <F4> o#include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1871
1146
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1872 To spot these problems, you can set the 'list' option when editing vimrc
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1873 files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1874
1146
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1875 For Unix there is one special way to comment a line, that allows making a Vim
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1876 script executable: >
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1877 #!/usr/bin/env vim -S
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1878 echo "this is a Vim script"
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1879 quit
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1880
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1881 The "#" command by itself lists a line with the line number. Adding an
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1882 exclamation mark changes it into doing nothing, so that you can add the shell
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1883 command to execute the rest of the file. |:#!| |-S|
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1884
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1885
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1886 PITFALLS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1887
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1888 Even bigger problem arises in the following example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1889
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1890 :map ,ab o#include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1891 :unmap ,ab
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1892
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1893 Here the unmap command will not work, because it tries to unmap ",ab ". This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1894 does not exist as a mapped sequence. An error will be issued, which is very
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1895 hard to identify, because the ending whitespace character in ":unmap ,ab " is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1896 not visible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1897
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1898 And this is the same as what happens when one uses a comment after an 'unmap'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1899 command: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1900
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1901 :unmap ,ab " comment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1902
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1903 Here the comment part will be ignored. However, Vim will try to unmap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1904 ',ab ', which does not exist. Rewrite it as: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1905
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1906 :unmap ,ab| " comment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1907
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1908
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1909 RESTORING THE VIEW
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1910
3893
c3036f1dca68 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3830
diff changeset
1911 Sometimes you want to make a change and go back to where the cursor was.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1912 Restoring the relative position would also be nice, so that the same line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1913 appears at the top of the window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1914 This example yanks the current line, puts it above the first line in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1915 file and then restores the view: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1916
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1917 map ,p ma"aYHmbgg"aP`bzt`a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1918
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1919 What this does: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1920 ma"aYHmbgg"aP`bzt`a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1921 < ma set mark a at cursor position
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1922 "aY yank current line into register a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1923 Hmb go to top line in window and set mark b there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1924 gg go to first line in file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1925 "aP put the yanked line above it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1926 `b go back to top line in display
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1927 zt position the text in the window as before
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1928 `a go back to saved cursor position
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1929
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1930
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1931 PACKAGING
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1932
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1933 To avoid your function names to interfere with functions that you get from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1934 others, use this scheme:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1935 - Prepend a unique string before each function name. I often use an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1936 abbreviation. For example, "OW_" is used for the option window functions.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1937 - Put the definition of your functions together in a file. Set a global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1938 variable to indicate that the functions have been loaded. When sourcing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1939 file again, first unload the functions.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1940 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1941
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1942 " This is the XXX package
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1943
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1944 if exists("XXX_loaded")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1945 delfun XXX_one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1946 delfun XXX_two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1947 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1948
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1949 function XXX_one(a)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1950 ... body of function ...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1951 endfun
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1952
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1953 function XXX_two(b)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1954 ... body of function ...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1955 endfun
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1956
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1957 let XXX_loaded = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1958
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1959 ==============================================================================
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1960 *41.11* Writing a plugin *write-plugin*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1961
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1962 You can write a Vim script in such a way that many people can use it. This is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1963 called a plugin. Vim users can drop your script in their plugin directory and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1964 use its features right away |add-plugin|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1965
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1966 There are actually two types of plugins:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1967
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1968 global plugins: For all types of files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1969 filetype plugins: Only for files of a specific type.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1970
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1971 In this section the first type is explained. Most items are also relevant for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1972 writing filetype plugins. The specifics for filetype plugins are in the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1973 section |write-filetype-plugin|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1974
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1975
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1976 NAME
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1977
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1978 First of all you must choose a name for your plugin. The features provided
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1979 by the plugin should be clear from its name. And it should be unlikely that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1980 someone else writes a plugin with the same name but which does something
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1981 different. And please limit the name to 8 characters, to avoid problems on
18912
ccd16426a1f9 patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 18879
diff changeset
1982 old MS-Windows systems.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1983
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1984 A script that corrects typing mistakes could be called "typecorr.vim". We
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1985 will use it here as an example.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1986
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1987 For the plugin to work for everybody, it should follow a few guidelines. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1988 will be explained step-by-step. The complete example plugin is at the end.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1989
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1990
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1991 BODY
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1992
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1993 Let's start with the body of the plugin, the lines that do the actual work: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1994
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1995 14 iabbrev teh the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1996 15 iabbrev otehr other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1997 16 iabbrev wnat want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1998 17 iabbrev synchronisation
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1999 18 \ synchronization
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2000 19 let s:count = 4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2001
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2002 The actual list should be much longer, of course.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2003
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2004 The line numbers have only been added to explain a few things, don't put them
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2005 in your plugin file!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2006
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2007
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2008 HEADER
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2009
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2010 You will probably add new corrections to the plugin and soon have several
3830
04592728474a Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3445
diff changeset
2011 versions lying around. And when distributing this file, people will want to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2012 know who wrote this wonderful plugin and where they can send remarks.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2013 Therefore, put a header at the top of your plugin: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2014
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2015 1 " Vim global plugin for correcting typing mistakes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2016 2 " Last Change: 2000 Oct 15
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2017 3 " Maintainer: Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2018
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2019 About copyright and licensing: Since plugins are very useful and it's hardly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2020 worth restricting their distribution, please consider making your plugin
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2021 either public domain or use the Vim |license|. A short note about this near
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2022 the top of the plugin should be sufficient. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2023
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2024 4 " License: This file is placed in the public domain.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2025
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2026
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2027 LINE CONTINUATION, AVOIDING SIDE EFFECTS *use-cpo-save*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2028
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2029 In line 18 above, the line-continuation mechanism is used |line-continuation|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2030 Users with 'compatible' set will run into trouble here, they will get an error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2031 message. We can't just reset 'compatible', because that has a lot of side
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2032 effects. To avoid this, we will set the 'cpoptions' option to its Vim default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2033 value and restore it later. That will allow the use of line-continuation and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2034 make the script work for most people. It is done like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2035
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2036 11 let s:save_cpo = &cpo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2037 12 set cpo&vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2038 ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2039 42 let &cpo = s:save_cpo
3445
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3237
diff changeset
2040 43 unlet s:save_cpo
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2041
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2042 We first store the old value of 'cpoptions' in the s:save_cpo variable. At
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2043 the end of the plugin this value is restored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2044
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2045 Notice that a script-local variable is used |s:var|. A global variable could
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2046 already be in use for something else. Always use script-local variables for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2047 things that are only used in the script.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2048
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2049
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2050 NOT LOADING
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2051
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2052 It's possible that a user doesn't always want to load this plugin. Or the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2053 system administrator has dropped it in the system-wide plugin directory, but a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2054 user has his own plugin he wants to use. Then the user must have a chance to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2055 disable loading this specific plugin. This will make it possible: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2056
2325
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
2057 6 if exists("g:loaded_typecorr")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2058 7 finish
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2059 8 endif
2325
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
2060 9 let g:loaded_typecorr = 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2061
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2062 This also avoids that when the script is loaded twice it would cause error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2063 messages for redefining functions and cause trouble for autocommands that are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2064 added twice.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2065
2325
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
2066 The name is recommended to start with "loaded_" and then the file name of the
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
2067 plugin, literally. The "g:" is prepended just to avoid mistakes when using
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
2068 the variable in a function (without "g:" it would be a variable local to the
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
2069 function).
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
2070
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
2071 Using "finish" stops Vim from reading the rest of the file, it's much quicker
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
2072 than using if-endif around the whole file.
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
2073
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2074
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2075 MAPPING
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2076
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2077 Now let's make the plugin more interesting: We will add a mapping that adds a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2078 correction for the word under the cursor. We could just pick a key sequence
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2079 for this mapping, but the user might already use it for something else. To
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2080 allow the user to define which keys a mapping in a plugin uses, the <Leader>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2081 item can be used: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2082
21825
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2083 22 map <unique> <Leader>a <Plug>TypecorrAdd;
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2084
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2085 The "<Plug>TypecorrAdd;" thing will do the work, more about that further on.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2086
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2087 The user can set the "mapleader" variable to the key sequence that he wants
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2088 this mapping to start with. Thus if the user has done: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2089
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2090 let mapleader = "_"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2091
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2092 the mapping will define "_a". If the user didn't do this, the default value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2093 will be used, which is a backslash. Then a map for "\a" will be defined.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2094
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2095 Note that <unique> is used, this will cause an error message if the mapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2096 already happened to exist. |:map-<unique>|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2097
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2098 But what if the user wants to define his own key sequence? We can allow that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2099 with this mechanism: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2100
21825
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2101 21 if !hasmapto('<Plug>TypecorrAdd;')
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2102 22 map <unique> <Leader>a <Plug>TypecorrAdd;
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2103 23 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2104
21991
bbca88cd13d5 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21989
diff changeset
2105 This checks if a mapping to "<Plug>TypecorrAdd;" already exists, and only
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2106 defines the mapping from "<Leader>a" if it doesn't. The user then has a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2107 chance of putting this in his vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2108
21825
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2109 map ,c <Plug>TypecorrAdd;
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2110
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2111 Then the mapped key sequence will be ",c" instead of "_a" or "\a".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2112
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2113
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2114 PIECES
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2115
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2116 If a script gets longer, you often want to break up the work in pieces. You
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2117 can use functions or mappings for this. But you don't want these functions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2118 and mappings to interfere with the ones from other scripts. For example, you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2119 could define a function Add(), but another script could try to define the same
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2120 function. To avoid this, we define the function local to the script by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2121 prepending it with "s:".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2122
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2123 We will define a function that adds a new typing correction: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2124
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2125 30 function s:Add(from, correct)
22171
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
2126 31 let to = input("type the correction for " .. a:from .. ": ")
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
2127 32 exe ":iabbrev " .. a:from .. " " .. to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2128 ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2129 36 endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2130
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2131 Now we can call the function s:Add() from within this script. If another
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2132 script also defines s:Add(), it will be local to that script and can only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2133 be called from the script it was defined in. There can also be a global Add()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2134 function (without the "s:"), which is again another function.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2135
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2136 <SID> can be used with mappings. It generates a script ID, which identifies
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2137 the current script. In our typing correction plugin we use it like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2138
21825
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2139 24 noremap <unique> <script> <Plug>TypecorrAdd; <SID>Add
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2140 ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2141 28 noremap <SID>Add :call <SID>Add(expand("<cword>"), 1)<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2142
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2143 Thus when a user types "\a", this sequence is invoked: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2144
21825
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2145 \a -> <Plug>TypecorrAdd; -> <SID>Add -> :call <SID>Add()
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2146
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2147 If another script also maps <SID>Add, it will get another script ID and
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2148 thus define another mapping.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2149
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2150 Note that instead of s:Add() we use <SID>Add() here. That is because the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2151 mapping is typed by the user, thus outside of the script. The <SID> is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2152 translated to the script ID, so that Vim knows in which script to look for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2153 the Add() function.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2154
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2155 This is a bit complicated, but it's required for the plugin to work together
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2156 with other plugins. The basic rule is that you use <SID>Add() in mappings and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2157 s:Add() in other places (the script itself, autocommands, user commands).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2158
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2159 We can also add a menu entry to do the same as the mapping: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2160
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2161 26 noremenu <script> Plugin.Add\ Correction <SID>Add
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2162
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2163 The "Plugin" menu is recommended for adding menu items for plugins. In this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2164 case only one item is used. When adding more items, creating a submenu is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2165 recommended. For example, "Plugin.CVS" could be used for a plugin that offers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2166 CVS operations "Plugin.CVS.checkin", "Plugin.CVS.checkout", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2167
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2168 Note that in line 28 ":noremap" is used to avoid that any other mappings cause
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2169 trouble. Someone may have remapped ":call", for example. In line 24 we also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2170 use ":noremap", but we do want "<SID>Add" to be remapped. This is why
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2171 "<script>" is used here. This only allows mappings which are local to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2172 script. |:map-<script>| The same is done in line 26 for ":noremenu".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2173 |:menu-<script>|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2174
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2175
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2176 <SID> AND <Plug> *using-<Plug>*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2177
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2178 Both <SID> and <Plug> are used to avoid that mappings of typed keys interfere
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2179 with mappings that are only to be used from other mappings. Note the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2180 difference between using <SID> and <Plug>:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2181
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2182 <Plug> is visible outside of the script. It is used for mappings which the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2183 user might want to map a key sequence to. <Plug> is a special code
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2184 that a typed key will never produce.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2185 To make it very unlikely that other plugins use the same sequence of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2186 characters, use this structure: <Plug> scriptname mapname
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2187 In our example the scriptname is "Typecorr" and the mapname is "Add".
21825
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2188 We add a semicolon as the terminator. This results in
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2189 "<Plug>TypecorrAdd;". Only the first character of scriptname and
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2190 mapname is uppercase, so that we can see where mapname starts.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2191
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2192 <SID> is the script ID, a unique identifier for a script.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2193 Internally Vim translates <SID> to "<SNR>123_", where "123" can be any
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2194 number. Thus a function "<SID>Add()" will have a name "<SNR>11_Add()"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2195 in one script, and "<SNR>22_Add()" in another. You can see this if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2196 you use the ":function" command to get a list of functions. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2197 translation of <SID> in mappings is exactly the same, that's how you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2198 can call a script-local function from a mapping.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2199
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2200
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2201 USER COMMAND
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2202
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2203 Now let's add a user command to add a correction: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2204
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2205 38 if !exists(":Correct")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2206 39 command -nargs=1 Correct :call s:Add(<q-args>, 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2207 40 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2208
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2209 The user command is defined only if no command with the same name already
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2210 exists. Otherwise we would get an error here. Overriding the existing user
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2211 command with ":command!" is not a good idea, this would probably make the user
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2212 wonder why the command he defined himself doesn't work. |:command|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2213
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2214
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2215 SCRIPT VARIABLES
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2216
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2217 When a variable starts with "s:" it is a script variable. It can only be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2218 inside a script. Outside the script it's not visible. This avoids trouble
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2219 with using the same variable name in different scripts. The variables will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2220 kept as long as Vim is running. And the same variables are used when sourcing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2221 the same script again. |s:var|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2222
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2223 The fun is that these variables can also be used in functions, autocommands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2224 and user commands that are defined in the script. In our example we can add
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2225 a few lines to count the number of corrections: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2226
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2227 19 let s:count = 4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2228 ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2229 30 function s:Add(from, correct)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2230 ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2231 34 let s:count = s:count + 1
22171
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
2232 35 echo s:count .. " corrections now"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2233 36 endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2234
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2235 First s:count is initialized to 4 in the script itself. When later the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2236 s:Add() function is called, it increments s:count. It doesn't matter from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2237 where the function was called, since it has been defined in the script, it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2238 will use the local variables from this script.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2239
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2240
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2241 THE RESULT
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2242
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2243 Here is the resulting complete example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2244
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2245 1 " Vim global plugin for correcting typing mistakes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2246 2 " Last Change: 2000 Oct 15
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2247 3 " Maintainer: Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2248 4 " License: This file is placed in the public domain.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2249 5
2325
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
2250 6 if exists("g:loaded_typecorr")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2251 7 finish
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2252 8 endif
2325
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
2253 9 let g:loaded_typecorr = 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2254 10
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2255 11 let s:save_cpo = &cpo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2256 12 set cpo&vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2257 13
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2258 14 iabbrev teh the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2259 15 iabbrev otehr other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2260 16 iabbrev wnat want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2261 17 iabbrev synchronisation
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2262 18 \ synchronization
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2263 19 let s:count = 4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2264 20
21825
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2265 21 if !hasmapto('<Plug>TypecorrAdd;')
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2266 22 map <unique> <Leader>a <Plug>TypecorrAdd;
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2267 23 endif
21825
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2268 24 noremap <unique> <script> <Plug>TypecorrAdd; <SID>Add
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2269 25
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2270 26 noremenu <script> Plugin.Add\ Correction <SID>Add
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2271 27
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2272 28 noremap <SID>Add :call <SID>Add(expand("<cword>"), 1)<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2273 29
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2274 30 function s:Add(from, correct)
22171
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
2275 31 let to = input("type the correction for " .. a:from .. ": ")
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
2276 32 exe ":iabbrev " .. a:from .. " " .. to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2277 33 if a:correct | exe "normal viws\<C-R>\" \b\e" | endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2278 34 let s:count = s:count + 1
22171
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
2279 35 echo s:count .. " corrections now"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2280 36 endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2281 37
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2282 38 if !exists(":Correct")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2283 39 command -nargs=1 Correct :call s:Add(<q-args>, 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2284 40 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2285 41
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2286 42 let &cpo = s:save_cpo
3445
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3237
diff changeset
2287 43 unlet s:save_cpo
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2288
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2289 Line 33 wasn't explained yet. It applies the new correction to the word under
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2290 the cursor. The |:normal| command is used to use the new abbreviation. Note
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2291 that mappings and abbreviations are expanded here, even though the function
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2292 was called from a mapping defined with ":noremap".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2293
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2294 Using "unix" for the 'fileformat' option is recommended. The Vim scripts will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2295 then work everywhere. Scripts with 'fileformat' set to "dos" do not work on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2296 Unix. Also see |:source_crnl|. To be sure it is set right, do this before
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2297 writing the file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2298
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2299 :set fileformat=unix
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2300
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2301
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2302 DOCUMENTATION *write-local-help*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2303
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2304 It's a good idea to also write some documentation for your plugin. Especially
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2305 when its behavior can be changed by the user. See |add-local-help| for how
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2306 they are installed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2307
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2308 Here is a simple example for a plugin help file, called "typecorr.txt": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2309
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2310 1 *typecorr.txt* Plugin for correcting typing mistakes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2311 2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2312 3 If you make typing mistakes, this plugin will have them corrected
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2313 4 automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2314 5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2315 6 There are currently only a few corrections. Add your own if you like.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2316 7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2317 8 Mappings:
21825
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2318 9 <Leader>a or <Plug>TypecorrAdd;
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2319 10 Add a correction for the word under the cursor.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2320 11
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2321 12 Commands:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2322 13 :Correct {word}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2323 14 Add a correction for {word}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2324 15
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2325 16 *typecorr-settings*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2326 17 This plugin doesn't have any settings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2327
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2328 The first line is actually the only one for which the format matters. It will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2329 be extracted from the help file to be put in the "LOCAL ADDITIONS:" section of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2330 help.txt |local-additions|. The first "*" must be in the first column of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2331 first line. After adding your help file do ":help" and check that the entries
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2332 line up nicely.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2333
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2334 You can add more tags inside ** in your help file. But be careful not to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2335 existing help tags. You would probably use the name of your plugin in most of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2336 them, like "typecorr-settings" in the example.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2337
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2338 Using references to other parts of the help in || is recommended. This makes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2339 it easy for the user to find associated help.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2340
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2341
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2342 FILETYPE DETECTION *plugin-filetype*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2343
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2344 If your filetype is not already detected by Vim, you should create a filetype
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2345 detection snippet in a separate file. It is usually in the form of an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2346 autocommand that sets the filetype when the file name matches a pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2347 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2348
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2349 au BufNewFile,BufRead *.foo set filetype=foofoo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2350
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2351 Write this single-line file as "ftdetect/foofoo.vim" in the first directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2352 that appears in 'runtimepath'. For Unix that would be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2353 "~/.vim/ftdetect/foofoo.vim". The convention is to use the name of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2354 filetype for the script name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2355
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2356 You can make more complicated checks if you like, for example to inspect the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2357 contents of the file to recognize the language. Also see |new-filetype|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2358
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2359
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2360 SUMMARY *plugin-special*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2361
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2362 Summary of special things to use in a plugin:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2363
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2364 s:name Variables local to the script.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2365
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2366 <SID> Script-ID, used for mappings and functions local to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2367 the script.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2368
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2369 hasmapto() Function to test if the user already defined a mapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2370 for functionality the script offers.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2371
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2372 <Leader> Value of "mapleader", which the user defines as the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2373 keys that plugin mappings start with.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2374
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2375 :map <unique> Give a warning if a mapping already exists.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2376
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2377 :noremap <script> Use only mappings local to the script, not global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2378 mappings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2379
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2380 exists(":Cmd") Check if a user command already exists.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2381
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2382 ==============================================================================
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
2383 *41.12* Writing a filetype plugin *write-filetype-plugin* *ftplugin*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2384
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2385 A filetype plugin is like a global plugin, except that it sets options and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2386 defines mappings for the current buffer only. See |add-filetype-plugin| for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2387 how this type of plugin is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2388
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
2389 First read the section on global plugins above |41.11|. All that is said there
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2390 also applies to filetype plugins. There are a few extras, which are explained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2391 here. The essential thing is that a filetype plugin should only have an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2392 effect on the current buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2393
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2394
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2395 DISABLING
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2396
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2397 If you are writing a filetype plugin to be used by many people, they need a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2398 chance to disable loading it. Put this at the top of the plugin: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2399
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2400 " Only do this when not done yet for this buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2401 if exists("b:did_ftplugin")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2402 finish
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2403 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2404 let b:did_ftplugin = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2405
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2406 This also needs to be used to avoid that the same plugin is executed twice for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2407 the same buffer (happens when using an ":edit" command without arguments).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2408
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2409 Now users can disable loading the default plugin completely by making a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2410 filetype plugin with only this line: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2411
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2412 let b:did_ftplugin = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2413
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2414 This does require that the filetype plugin directory comes before $VIMRUNTIME
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2415 in 'runtimepath'!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2416
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2417 If you do want to use the default plugin, but overrule one of the settings,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2418 you can write the different setting in a script: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2419
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2420 setlocal textwidth=70
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2421
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2422 Now write this in the "after" directory, so that it gets sourced after the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2423 distributed "vim.vim" ftplugin |after-directory|. For Unix this would be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2424 "~/.vim/after/ftplugin/vim.vim". Note that the default plugin will have set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2425 "b:did_ftplugin", but it is ignored here.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2426
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2427
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2428 OPTIONS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2429
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2430 To make sure the filetype plugin only affects the current buffer use the >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2431
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2432 :setlocal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2433
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2434 command to set options. And only set options which are local to a buffer (see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2435 the help for the option to check that). When using |:setlocal| for global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2436 options or options local to a window, the value will change for many buffers,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2437 and that is not what a filetype plugin should do.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2438
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2439 When an option has a value that is a list of flags or items, consider using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2440 "+=" and "-=" to keep the existing value. Be aware that the user may have
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2441 changed an option value already. First resetting to the default value and
2698
b6471224d2af Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2662
diff changeset
2442 then changing it is often a good idea. Example: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2443
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2444 :setlocal formatoptions& formatoptions+=ro
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2445
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2446
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2447 MAPPINGS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2448
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2449 To make sure mappings will only work in the current buffer use the >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2450
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2451 :map <buffer>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2452
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2453 command. This needs to be combined with the two-step mapping explained above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2454 An example of how to define functionality in a filetype plugin: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2455
21825
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2456 if !hasmapto('<Plug>JavaImport;')
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2457 map <buffer> <unique> <LocalLeader>i <Plug>JavaImport;
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2458 endif
21825
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2459 noremap <buffer> <unique> <Plug>JavaImport; oimport ""<Left><Esc>
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2460
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2461 |hasmapto()| is used to check if the user has already defined a map to
21825
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2462 <Plug>JavaImport;. If not, then the filetype plugin defines the default
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2463 mapping. This starts with |<LocalLeader>|, which allows the user to select
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2464 the key(s) he wants filetype plugin mappings to start with. The default is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2465 backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2466 "<unique>" is used to give an error message if the mapping already exists or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2467 overlaps with an existing mapping.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2468 |:noremap| is used to avoid that any other mappings that the user has defined
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2469 interferes. You might want to use ":noremap <script>" to allow remapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2470 mappings defined in this script that start with <SID>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2471
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2472 The user must have a chance to disable the mappings in a filetype plugin,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2473 without disabling everything. Here is an example of how this is done for a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2474 plugin for the mail filetype: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2475
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2476 " Add mappings, unless the user didn't want this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2477 if !exists("no_plugin_maps") && !exists("no_mail_maps")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2478 " Quote text by inserting "> "
21825
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2479 if !hasmapto('<Plug>MailQuote;')
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2480 vmap <buffer> <LocalLeader>q <Plug>MailQuote;
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2481 nmap <buffer> <LocalLeader>q <Plug>MailQuote;
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2482 endif
21825
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2483 vnoremap <buffer> <Plug>MailQuote; :s/^/> /<CR>
0db0640e16e0 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 21676
diff changeset
2484 nnoremap <buffer> <Plug>MailQuote; :.,$s/^/> /<CR>
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2485 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2486
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2487 Two global variables are used:
11262
214f228718cf Update runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11229
diff changeset
2488 |no_plugin_maps| disables mappings for all filetype plugins
214f228718cf Update runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11229
diff changeset
2489 |no_mail_maps| disables mappings for the "mail" filetype
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2490
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2491
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2492 USER COMMANDS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2493
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2494 To add a user command for a specific file type, so that it can only be used in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2495 one buffer, use the "-buffer" argument to |:command|. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2496
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2497 :command -buffer Make make %:r.s
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2498
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2499
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2500 VARIABLES
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2501
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2502 A filetype plugin will be sourced for each buffer of the type it's for. Local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2503 script variables |s:var| will be shared between all invocations. Use local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2504 buffer variables |b:var| if you want a variable specifically for one buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2505
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2506
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2507 FUNCTIONS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2508
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2509 When defining a function, this only needs to be done once. But the filetype
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2510 plugin will be sourced every time a file with this filetype will be opened.
2207
b17bbfa96fa0 Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
2511 This construct makes sure the function is only defined once: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2512
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2513 :if !exists("*s:Func")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2514 : function s:Func(arg)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2515 : ...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2516 : endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2517 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2518 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2519
8061
abd64cf67bcf commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/38a55639d603823efcf2d2fdf542dbffdeb60b75
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7924
diff changeset
2520 UNDO *undo_indent* *undo_ftplugin*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2521
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2522 When the user does ":setfiletype xyz" the effect of the previous filetype
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2523 should be undone. Set the b:undo_ftplugin variable to the commands that will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2524 undo the settings in your filetype plugin. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2525
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2526 let b:undo_ftplugin = "setlocal fo< com< tw< commentstring<"
22171
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
2527 \ .. "| unlet b:match_ignorecase b:match_words b:match_skip"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2528
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2529 Using ":setlocal" with "<" after the option name resets the option to its
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2530 global value. That is mostly the best way to reset the option value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2531
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2532 This does require removing the "C" flag from 'cpoptions' to allow line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2533 continuation, as mentioned above |use-cpo-save|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2534
8061
abd64cf67bcf commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/38a55639d603823efcf2d2fdf542dbffdeb60b75
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7924
diff changeset
2535 For undoing the effect of an indent script, the b:undo_indent variable should
abd64cf67bcf commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/38a55639d603823efcf2d2fdf542dbffdeb60b75
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7924
diff changeset
2536 be set accordingly.
abd64cf67bcf commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/38a55639d603823efcf2d2fdf542dbffdeb60b75
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7924
diff changeset
2537
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2538
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2539 FILE NAME
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2540
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2541 The filetype must be included in the file name |ftplugin-name|. Use one of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2542 these three forms:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2543
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2544 .../ftplugin/stuff.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2545 .../ftplugin/stuff_foo.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2546 .../ftplugin/stuff/bar.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2547
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2548 "stuff" is the filetype, "foo" and "bar" are arbitrary names.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2549
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2550
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2551 SUMMARY *ftplugin-special*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2552
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2553 Summary of special things to use in a filetype plugin:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2554
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2555 <LocalLeader> Value of "maplocalleader", which the user defines as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2556 the keys that filetype plugin mappings start with.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2557
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2558 :map <buffer> Define a mapping local to the buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2559
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2560 :noremap <script> Only remap mappings defined in this script that start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2561 with <SID>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2562
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2563 :setlocal Set an option for the current buffer only.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2564
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2565 :command -buffer Define a user command local to the buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2566
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2567 exists("*s:Func") Check if a function was already defined.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2568
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2569 Also see |plugin-special|, the special things used for all plugins.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2570
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2571 ==============================================================================
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
2572 *41.13* Writing a compiler plugin *write-compiler-plugin*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2573
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2574 A compiler plugin sets options for use with a specific compiler. The user can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2575 load it with the |:compiler| command. The main use is to set the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2576 'errorformat' and 'makeprg' options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2577
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2578 Easiest is to have a look at examples. This command will edit all the default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2579 compiler plugins: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2580
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2581 :next $VIMRUNTIME/compiler/*.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2582
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2583 Use |:next| to go to the next plugin file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2584
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2585 There are two special items about these files. First is a mechanism to allow
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2586 a user to overrule or add to the default file. The default files start with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2587
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2588 :if exists("current_compiler")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2589 : finish
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2590 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2591 :let current_compiler = "mine"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2592
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2593 When you write a compiler file and put it in your personal runtime directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2594 (e.g., ~/.vim/compiler for Unix), you set the "current_compiler" variable to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2595 make the default file skip the settings.
570
27d1ec742f17 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 434
diff changeset
2596 *:CompilerSet*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2597 The second mechanism is to use ":set" for ":compiler!" and ":setlocal" for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2598 ":compiler". Vim defines the ":CompilerSet" user command for this. However,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2599 older Vim versions don't, thus your plugin should define it then. This is an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2600 example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2601
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2602 if exists(":CompilerSet") != 2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2603 command -nargs=* CompilerSet setlocal <args>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2604 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2605 CompilerSet errorformat& " use the default 'errorformat'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2606 CompilerSet makeprg=nmake
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2607
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2608 When you write a compiler plugin for the Vim distribution or for a system-wide
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2609 runtime directory, use the mechanism mentioned above. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2610 "current_compiler" was already set by a user plugin nothing will be done.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2611
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2612 When you write a compiler plugin to overrule settings from a default plugin,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2613 don't check "current_compiler". This plugin is supposed to be loaded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2614 last, thus it should be in a directory at the end of 'runtimepath'. For Unix
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2615 that could be ~/.vim/after/compiler.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2616
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2617 ==============================================================================
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2618 *41.14* Writing a plugin that loads quickly *write-plugin-quickload*
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2619
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2620 A plugin may grow and become quite long. The startup delay may become
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
2621 noticeable, while you hardly ever use the plugin. Then it's time for a
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2622 quickload plugin.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2623
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2624 The basic idea is that the plugin is loaded twice. The first time user
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2625 commands and mappings are defined that offer the functionality. The second
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2626 time the functions that implement the functionality are defined.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2627
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2628 It may sound surprising that quickload means loading a script twice. What we
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2629 mean is that it loads quickly the first time, postponing the bulk of the
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2630 script to the second time, which only happens when you actually use it. When
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2631 you always use the functionality it actually gets slower!
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2632
793
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2633 Note that since Vim 7 there is an alternative: use the |autoload|
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2634 functionality |41.15|.
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2635
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2636 The following example shows how it's done: >
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2637
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2638 " Vim global plugin for demonstrating quick loading
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2639 " Last Change: 2005 Feb 25
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2640 " Maintainer: Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2641 " License: This file is placed in the public domain.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2642
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2643 if !exists("s:did_load")
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2644 command -nargs=* BNRead call BufNetRead(<f-args>)
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2645 map <F19> :call BufNetWrite('something')<CR>
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2646
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2647 let s:did_load = 1
22171
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
2648 exe 'au FuncUndefined BufNet* source ' .. expand('<sfile>')
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2649 finish
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2650 endif
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2651
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2652 function BufNetRead(...)
22171
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
2653 echo 'BufNetRead(' .. string(a:000) .. ')'
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2654 " read functionality here
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2655 endfunction
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2656
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2657 function BufNetWrite(...)
22171
d4c7b3e9cd17 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents: 22077
diff changeset
2658 echo 'BufNetWrite(' .. string(a:000) .. ')'
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2659 " write functionality here
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2660 endfunction
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2661
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2662 When the script is first loaded "s:did_load" is not set. The commands between
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2663 the "if" and "endif" will be executed. This ends in a |:finish| command, thus
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2664 the rest of the script is not executed.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2665
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2666 The second time the script is loaded "s:did_load" exists and the commands
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2667 after the "endif" are executed. This defines the (possible long)
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2668 BufNetRead() and BufNetWrite() functions.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2669
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2670 If you drop this script in your plugin directory Vim will execute it on
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2671 startup. This is the sequence of events that happens:
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2672
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2673 1. The "BNRead" command is defined and the <F19> key is mapped when the script
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2674 is sourced at startup. A |FuncUndefined| autocommand is defined. The
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2675 ":finish" command causes the script to terminate early.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2676
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2677 2. The user types the BNRead command or presses the <F19> key. The
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2678 BufNetRead() or BufNetWrite() function will be called.
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
2679
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2680 3. Vim can't find the function and triggers the |FuncUndefined| autocommand
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2681 event. Since the pattern "BufNet*" matches the invoked function, the
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2682 command "source fname" will be executed. "fname" will be equal to the name
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2683 of the script, no matter where it is located, because it comes from
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2684 expanding "<sfile>" (see |expand()|).
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2685
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2686 4. The script is sourced again, the "s:did_load" variable exists and the
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2687 functions are defined.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2688
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2689 Notice that the functions that are loaded afterwards match the pattern in the
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2690 |FuncUndefined| autocommand. You must make sure that no other plugin defines
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2691 functions that match this pattern.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2692
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2693 ==============================================================================
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2694 *41.15* Writing library scripts *write-library-script*
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2695
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2696 Some functionality will be required in several places. When this becomes more
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2697 than a few lines you will want to put it in one script and use it from many
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2698 scripts. We will call that one script a library script.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2699
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2700 Manually loading a library script is possible, so long as you avoid loading it
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2701 when it's already done. You can do this with the |exists()| function.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2702 Example: >
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2703
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2704 if !exists('*MyLibFunction')
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2705 runtime library/mylibscript.vim
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2706 endif
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2707 call MyLibFunction(arg)
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2708
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2709 Here you need to know that MyLibFunction() is defined in a script
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2710 "library/mylibscript.vim" in one of the directories in 'runtimepath'.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2711
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2712 To make this a bit simpler Vim offers the autoload mechanism. Then the
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2713 example looks like this: >
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2714
270
a20218704019 updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 230
diff changeset
2715 call mylib#myfunction(arg)
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2716
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2717 That's a lot simpler, isn't it? Vim will recognize the function name and when
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2718 it's not defined search for the script "autoload/mylib.vim" in 'runtimepath'.
270
a20218704019 updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 230
diff changeset
2719 That script must define the "mylib#myfunction()" function.
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2720
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2721 You can put many other functions in the mylib.vim script, you are free to
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2722 organize your functions in library scripts. But you must use function names
323
03b3684919e3 updated for version 7.0084
vimboss
parents: 270
diff changeset
2723 where the part before the '#' matches the script name. Otherwise Vim would
03b3684919e3 updated for version 7.0084
vimboss
parents: 270
diff changeset
2724 not know what script to load.
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2725
681
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 667
diff changeset
2726 If you get really enthusiastic and write lots of library scripts, you may
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2727 want to use subdirectories. Example: >
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2728
270
a20218704019 updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 230
diff changeset
2729 call netlib#ftp#read('somefile')
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2730
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2731 For Unix the library script used for this could be:
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2732
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2733 ~/.vim/autoload/netlib/ftp.vim
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2734
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2735 Where the function is defined like this: >
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2736
270
a20218704019 updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 230
diff changeset
2737 function netlib#ftp#read(fname)
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2738 " Read the file fname through ftp
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2739 endfunction
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2740
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2741 Notice that the name the function is defined with is exactly the same as the
323
03b3684919e3 updated for version 7.0084
vimboss
parents: 270
diff changeset
2742 name used for calling the function. And the part before the last '#'
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2743 exactly matches the subdirectory and script name.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2744
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2745 You can use the same mechanism for variables: >
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2746
270
a20218704019 updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 230
diff changeset
2747 let weekdays = dutch#weekdays
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2748
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2749 This will load the script "autoload/dutch.vim", which should contain something
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2750 like: >
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2751
270
a20218704019 updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 230
diff changeset
2752 let dutch#weekdays = ['zondag', 'maandag', 'dinsdag', 'woensdag',
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2753 \ 'donderdag', 'vrijdag', 'zaterdag']
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2754
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2755 Further reading: |autoload|.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2756
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2757 ==============================================================================
793
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2758 *41.16* Distributing Vim scripts *distribute-script*
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2759
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2760 Vim users will look for scripts on the Vim website: http://www.vim.org.
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2761 If you made something that is useful for others, share it!
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2762
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2763 Vim scripts can be used on any system. There might not be a tar or gzip
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2764 command. If you want to pack files together and/or compress them the "zip"
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2765 utility is recommended.
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2766
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2767 For utmost portability use Vim itself to pack scripts together. This can be
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2768 done with the Vimball utility. See |vimball|.
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2769
799
6beb2c667935 updated for version 7.0b
vimboss
parents: 793
diff changeset
2770 It's good if you add a line to allow automatic updating. See |glvs-plugins|.
6beb2c667935 updated for version 7.0b
vimboss
parents: 793
diff changeset
2771
793
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2772 ==============================================================================
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2773
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2774 Next chapter: |usr_42.txt| Add new menus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2775
14519
5c5908e81e93 Update runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 14004
diff changeset
2776 Copyright: see |manual-copyright| vim:tw=78:ts=8:noet:ft=help:norl: